blob: ce81183fd7aff674bea534d9190cfbc9783ce26c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8234f6d2016-03-14 00:10:05 +01007 2016/03/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106
1071. Quick reminder about HTTP
108----------------------------
109
110When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
111fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
112on almost anything found in the contents.
113
114However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
115formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
116correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
117
118
1191.1. The HTTP transaction model
120-------------------------------
121
122The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100123to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
125connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
126will involve a new connection :
127
128 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
129
130In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
131establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
132by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
133length.
134
135Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
136to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
137however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
138response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
139header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
144power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
145but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200146a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147
148A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
149keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
150second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
151page :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
156latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
157correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
158the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100159server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100161By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
162connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
163leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
164start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
167 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
168 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
169 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
170 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
171 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
172 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174
1751.2. HTTP request
176-----------------
177
178First, let's consider this HTTP request :
179
180 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100181 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
183 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
184 3 User-agent: my small browser
185 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
186 5 Accept: image/png
187
188
1891.2.1. The Request line
190-----------------------
191
192Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
193
194 - a METHOD : GET
195 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
197
198All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
199which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
200followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
201is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
202desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
203the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
204
205The URI itself can have several forms :
206
207 - A "relative URI" :
208
209 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
210
211 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
212 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
213
214 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
215
216 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
217
218 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
219 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
220 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
221 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
222 must accept this form too.
223
224 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
225 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
226 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
229 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
230 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
231 other protocols too.
232
233In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
234mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
235on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
236It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
237specific to the language, framework or application in use.
238
239
2401.2.2. The request headers
241--------------------------
242
243The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
244beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
245an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
246Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
247values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
248encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
249the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
250define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
251
252Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
253their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
254"Connection:" header).
255
256The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
257that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
258is one valid form of empty line.
259
260Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
261headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
262about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
263application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
264
265Important note:
266 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
267 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
268 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
269 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
270
271
2721.3. HTTP response
273------------------
274
275An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
276messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
277
278 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100279 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
281 2 Content-length: 350
282 3 Content-Type: text/html
283
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
285codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
286response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100287continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
288the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
289following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
290sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
291(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
292correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
293such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
294state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
295over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
296if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
297information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
3001.3.1. The Response line
301------------------------
302
303Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
304
305 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
306 - a status code : 200
307 - a reason : OK
308
309The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200310 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
312 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
313 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
314 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
315
316Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
319messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
320or "Authentication Required".
321
322Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
323
324 Code When / reason
325 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
326 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100329 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331 400 for an invalid or too large request
332 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
333 accessing the stats page)
334 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
335 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
336 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
337 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
338 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
339 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
340 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
341 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
342 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
343
344The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3454.2).
346
347
3481.3.2. The response headers
349---------------------------
350
351Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
352the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
353details.
354
355
3562. Configuring HAProxy
357----------------------
358
3592.1. Configuration file format
360------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200361
362HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
363
364 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
365 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
366 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
367 "frontend" and "backend".
368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
370referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200371delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003742.2. Quoting and escaping
375-------------------------
376
377HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
378many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
379with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
380single quotes.
381
382If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
383them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
384escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
385
386Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
387
388 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
389 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
390 \\ to use a backslash
391 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
392 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
393
394Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
395the interpretation of:
396
397 space as a parameter separator
398 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
399 # hash as a comment start
400
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200401Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
402-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
403backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
404
405Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200406quoting.
407
408Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
409nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
410
411Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
412equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
413
414 Example:
415 # those are equivalents:
416 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
417 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
418 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
419 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
421
422 # those are equivalents:
423 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
424 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
425 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
426 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
427
428
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004292.3. Environment variables
430--------------------------
431
432HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
433interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
434configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
435optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
436shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
437underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
438
439 Example:
440
441 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
442
443 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
444
445 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
446
447
4482.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200449----------------
450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100451Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100452values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
453otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
454numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
455for every keyword. Supported units are :
456
457 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
458 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
459 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
460 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
461 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
462 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
463
464
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004652.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200466-------------
467
468 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
469 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
470 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
471 global
472 daemon
473 maxconn 256
474
475 defaults
476 mode http
477 timeout connect 5000ms
478 timeout client 50000ms
479 timeout server 50000ms
480
481 frontend http-in
482 bind *:80
483 default_backend servers
484
485 backend servers
486 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
487
488
489 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
490 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
491 global
492 daemon
493 maxconn 256
494
495 defaults
496 mode http
497 timeout connect 5000ms
498 timeout client 50000ms
499 timeout server 50000ms
500
501 listen http-in
502 bind *:80
503 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
504
505
506Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
507
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100508 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200509
510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005113. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512--------------------
513
514Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
515are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
516of them have command-line equivalents.
517
518The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
519
520 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200524 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200526 - description
527 - deviceatlas-json-file
528 - deviceatlas-log-level
529 - deviceatlas-separator
530 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900531 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200532 - gid
533 - group
534 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200535 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100536 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200537 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100541 - presetenv
542 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - uid
544 - ulimit-n
545 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100546 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200547 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200548 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
549 - ssl-default-bind-options
550 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
551 - ssl-default-server-options
552 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100553 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100554 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100555 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100556 - 51degrees-data-file
557 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200558 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200559 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200562 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200564 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100565 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100566 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100567 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200568 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200569 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200570 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572 - noepoll
573 - nokqueue
574 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100575 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300576 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200577 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200578 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200579 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200580 - tune.buffers.limit
581 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200582 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200583 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100584 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100585 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200586 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100587 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100588 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100589 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100590 - tune.lua.session-timeout
591 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200592 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100593 - tune.maxaccept
594 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200595 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200596 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200597 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100598 - tune.rcvbuf.client
599 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100600 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100601 - tune.sndbuf.client
602 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100603 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100604 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200605 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100606 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200607 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200608 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200609 - tune.vars.global-max-size
610 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
611 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
612 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100613 - tune.zlib.memlevel
614 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100615
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 * Debugging
617 - debug
618 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200619
620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006213.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622------------------------------------
623
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200624ca-base <dir>
625 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200626 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
627 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629chroot <jail dir>
630 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
631 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
632 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
633 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
634 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
635 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100636
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100637cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
638 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
639 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
640 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100641 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
642 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
643 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
644 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
645 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
646 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
647 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
648 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
649 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
650 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100651
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200652crt-base <dir>
653 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
654 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
655 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657daemon
658 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
659 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
660 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
661
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200662deviceatlas-json-file <path>
663 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
664 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
665
666deviceatlas-log-level <value>
667 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
668 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
669
670deviceatlas-separator <char>
671 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
672 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
673
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100674deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200675 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
676 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
677 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100678
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900679external-check
680 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
681 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
682 See "option external-check".
683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200684gid <number>
685 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
686 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
687 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100688 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
689 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200690 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692group <group name>
693 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
694 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100695
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200696log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
698 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100699 configured with "log global".
700
701 <address> can be one of:
702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100703 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100704 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
705 port).
706
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100707 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
708 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
709 port).
710
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100711 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
712 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
713 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
714 writeable).
715
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200716 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
717 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100718
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200719 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
720 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
721 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
722 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
723 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
724 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
725 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
726 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
727 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
728 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
729 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
730
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200731 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
732 one of the following :
733
734 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
735 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
736
737 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
738 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
739
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100740 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200741
742 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
743 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
744 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
745
746 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200747 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
748 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
749 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
750 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
751 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
752 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200754 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200755
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100756log-send-hostname [<string>]
757 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
758 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
759 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
760 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
761 the logs.
762
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000763log-tag <string>
764 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
765 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
766 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100767 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000768
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100769lua-load <file>
770 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
771 used multiple times.
772
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773nbproc <number>
774 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
775 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
776 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
777 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
778 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
779
780pidfile <pidfile>
781 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
782 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
783 starting the process. See also "daemon".
784
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100785presetenv <name> <value>
786 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
787 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
788 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
789 and "unsetenv".
790
791resetenv [<name> ...]
792 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
793 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
794 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
795 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
796 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
797 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
798 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
799 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
800
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100801stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200802 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
803 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
804 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
805 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
806 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
807 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100808 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200809 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
810 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200811
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200812server-state-base <directory>
813 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200814 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
815 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200816
817server-state-file <file>
818 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
819 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
820 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
821 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
822 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
823 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
824 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
825 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200826 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
827 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200828
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100829setenv <name> <value>
830 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
831 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
832 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
833 and "unsetenv".
834
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100835ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
837 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300838 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100839 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
840 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
841 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
842 "bind" keyword for more information.
843
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100844ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
845 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
846 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
847 keyword to see available options.
848
849 Example:
850 global
851 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
852
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100853ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
855 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300856 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100857 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
858 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
859 information.
860
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100861ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
863 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
864 keyword to see available options.
865
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200866ssl-dh-param-file <file>
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
869 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
870 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
871 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200872 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
873 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
874 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
875 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200876 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
877 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
878 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
879
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100880ssl-server-verify [none|required]
881 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
882 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
883 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
884
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200885stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
886 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
887 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
888 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200889 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
890 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200891
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200892 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
893 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
894 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200895
896stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
897 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
898 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100899 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200900
901stats maxconn <connections>
902 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
903 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
904
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200905uid <number>
906 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
907 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
908 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
909 one. See also "gid" and "user".
910
911ulimit-n <number>
912 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
913 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
914 option.
915
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100916unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
917 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
918
919 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
920 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
921 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
922 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
923 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
924 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
925 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
926 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
927 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
928 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
929
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100930unsetenv [<name> ...]
931 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
932 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
933 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
934 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
935 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
936 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
937 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
938
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200939user <user name>
940 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
941 See also "uid" and "group".
942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200943node <name>
944 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
945
946 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
947 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
948 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
949 traffic.
950
951description <text>
952 Add a text that describes the instance.
953
954 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
955 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
956 "<" and ">" characters.
957
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010095851degrees-data-file <file path>
959 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
960 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
961
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200962 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100963 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
964
96551degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
966 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
967 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
968 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
969
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200970 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100971 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
972
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100974 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
975 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
976
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200977 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
978 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
979
98051degrees-cache-size <number>
981 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
982 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
983 By default, this cache is disabled.
984
985 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100986 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
987
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009893.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200990-----------------------
991
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200992max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
993 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
994 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
995 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
996 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
997 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
998 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
999 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1000 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1001
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002maxconn <number>
1003 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1004 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1005 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001006 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1007 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1008 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1009 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001010 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1011 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1012 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1013 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1014 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001015
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001016maxconnrate <number>
1017 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1018 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1019 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1020 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1021 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1022 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1023 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1024 fairness.
1025
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001026maxcomprate <number>
1027 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001028 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001029 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1030 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1031 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1032 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1033 default value.
1034
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001035maxcompcpuusage <number>
1036 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1037 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1038 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1039 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1040 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1041 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1042 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1043 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1044
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001045maxpipes <number>
1046 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1047 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1048 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1049 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1050 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1051 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1052
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001053maxsessrate <number>
1054 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1055 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1056 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1057 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1058 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1059 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1060 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1061 fairness.
1062
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001063maxsslconn <number>
1064 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1065 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1066 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1067 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1068 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1069 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1070 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001071 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1072 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1073 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1074 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1075 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1076 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1077 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001078
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001079maxsslrate <number>
1080 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1081 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1082 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1083 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1084 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1085 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1086 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1087 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1088 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1089 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1090
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001091maxzlibmem <number>
1092 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1093 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1094 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001095 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1096 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1097 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1098
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099noepoll
1100 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1101 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001102 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103
1104nokqueue
1105 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1106 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1107 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1108
1109nopoll
1110 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1111 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001112 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001113 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001115nosplice
1116 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1117 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1118 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001119 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001120 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1121 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1122 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1123 "option splice-response".
1124
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001125nogetaddrinfo
1126 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1127 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1128
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001129spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001130 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1131 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1132 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1133 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1134 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1135 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001136
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001137tune.buffers.limit <number>
1138 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1139 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1140 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1141 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1142 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1143 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1144 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1145 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1146 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1147 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1148 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1149 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1150 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1151 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1152 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1153
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001154tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1155 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1156 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1157 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1158 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1159
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001160tune.bufsize <number>
1161 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1162 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1163 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1164 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1165 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1166 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1167 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1168 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001169 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1170 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1171 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001172
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001173tune.chksize <number>
1174 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1175 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1176 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1177 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1178 checks whenever possible.
1179
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001180tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1181 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1182 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1183 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1184 this value. The default value is 1.
1185
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001186tune.http.cookielen <number>
1187 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1188 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1189 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1190 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1191 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1192 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1193 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1194 to change this value.
1195
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001196tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1197 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1198 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1199 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1200 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1201 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1202 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1203 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1204 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1205 limit too high.
1206
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001207tune.idletimer <timeout>
1208 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1209 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1210 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1211 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1212 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1213 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1214 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1215 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1216 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1217
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001218tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1219 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1220 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1221 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1222 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1223 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1224 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1225 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1226
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001227tune.lua.maxmem
1228 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1229 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1230 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1231 memory.
1232
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001233tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1234 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001235 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1236 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1237 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001238
1239tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1240 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1241 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1242 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1243 check servers.
1244
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001245tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1246 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1247 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1248 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1249 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1250
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001251tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001252 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1253 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1254 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1255 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1256 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1257 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1258 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1259 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1260 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1261 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001262
1263tune.maxpollevents <number>
1264 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1265 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1266 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1267 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1268 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1269
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001270tune.maxrewrite <number>
1271 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1272 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1273 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1274 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1275 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1276 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1277 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1278 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1279 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1280 bufsize.
1281
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001282tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1283 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1284 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1285 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1286 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1287 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1288 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1289 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1290 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1291 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1292 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1293 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1294 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1295 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1296 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1297 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1298 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1299 setting this parameter to 0.
1300
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001301tune.pipesize <number>
1302 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1303 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1304 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1305 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1306 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1307 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1308
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001309tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1310tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1311 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1312 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1313 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1314 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1315 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1316 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1317 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1318
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001319tune.recv_enough <number>
1320 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1321 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1322 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1323 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1324 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1325
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001326tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1327tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1328 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1329 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1330 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1331 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1332 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1333 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1334 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1335 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1336 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1337 notifying haproxy again.
1338
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001339tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001340 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1341 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1342 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001343 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001344 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1345 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1346 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1347 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1348 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001349 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1350 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001351
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001352tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1353 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1354 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1355 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1356 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1357 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1358 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1359
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001360tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1361 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001362 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001363 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1364 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1365 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1366 being used for too long.
1367
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001368tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1369 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1370 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1371 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1372 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1373 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1374 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1375 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1376 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1377 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1378 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001379 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1380 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001381
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001382tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1383 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1384 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1385 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1386 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1387 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1388 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1389 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001390 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1391 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001392
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001393tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1394 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1395 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1396 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1397 1000 entries.
1398
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001399tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1400tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1401tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1402tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001403 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1404 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1405 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1406 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1407 response processing.
1408 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1409 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1410 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001411
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001412 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1413 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1414 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1415 all available space is consumed.
1416 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1417 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1418 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001419
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001420tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1421 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001422 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001423 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1424 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1425 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1426
1427tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1428 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1429 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1430 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1431 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014333.3. Debugging
1434--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001435
1436debug
1437 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1438 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1439 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1440 system startup.
1441
1442quiet
1443 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1444 line argument "-q".
1445
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001446
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014473.4. Userlists
1448--------------
1449It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1450http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1451it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1452
1453userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001454 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001455 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1456
1457group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001458 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001459 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1460 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1461
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001462user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1463 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001464 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1465 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001466 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1467 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001469 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001470
1471
1472 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001473 userlist L1
1474 group G1 users tiger,scott
1475 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001476
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001477 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1478 user scott insecure-password elgato
1479 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001480
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001481 userlist L2
1482 group G1
1483 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001484
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001485 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1486 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1487 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001488
1489 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001490
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001491
14923.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001493----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001494It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1495several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1496instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1497values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1498automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1499In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1500using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1501tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1502reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1503Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1504that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1505each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001506
1507peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001508 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001509 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1510
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001511disabled
1512 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1513 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1514 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1515
1516enable
1517 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1518
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001519peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1520 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1521 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1522 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1523 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1524 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1525 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1526
1527 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1528 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1529
1530 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1531 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1532 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1533 across all peers.
1534
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001535 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1536 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001537
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001538 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001539 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001540 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1541 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1542 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001543
1544 backend mybackend
1545 mode tcp
1546 balance roundrobin
1547 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1548 stick on src
1549
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001550 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1551 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001552
1553
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015543.6. Mailers
1555------------
1556It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1557If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1558in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1559
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001560mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001561 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1562 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1563
1564mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1565 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1566
1567 Example:
1568 mailers mymailers
1569 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1570 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1571
1572 backend mybackend
1573 mode tcp
1574 balance roundrobin
1575
1576 email-alert mailers mymailers
1577 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1578 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1579
1580 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1581 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1582
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001583timeout mail <time>
1584 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1585 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1586 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1587 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1588
1589 Example:
1590 mailers mymailers
1591 timeout mail 20s
1592 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015944. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001595----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001596
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001597Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001598 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001599 - frontend <name>
1600 - backend <name>
1601 - listen <name>
1602
1603A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1604its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1605section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001607
1608A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1609connections.
1610
1611A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1612to forward incoming connections.
1613
1614A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1615parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1618'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1619case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1620
1621Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1622logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1623proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1624However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1625name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1626
1627Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1628and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001629bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001630protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1631modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1632arbitrary criteria.
1633
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001634In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1635a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1636the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1637
1638 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1639 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1640 between responses and new requests.
1641
1642 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1643 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1644 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1645 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1646
1647 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1648 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1649 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1650
1651 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1652 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1653 client-facing connection remains open.
1654
1655 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1656 after the end of the response.
1657
1658The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1659frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1660following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1661weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1662
1663 Backend mode
1664
1665 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1666 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1667 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1668 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1669 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1670 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1671 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1672 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1673 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1674 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1675 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016794.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1680--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001682The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1683limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1684they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1685limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001686marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001687option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001688and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1689with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1690specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001692
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001693 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1694------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1695acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001696appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001697backlog X X X -
1698balance X - X X
1699bind - X X -
1700bind-process X X X X
1701block - X X X
1702capture cookie - X X -
1703capture request header - X X -
1704capture response header - X X -
1705clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001706compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001707contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1708cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001709declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001710default-server X - X X
1711default_backend X X X -
1712description - X X X
1713disabled X X X X
1714dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001715email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001716email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001717email-alert mailers X X X X
1718email-alert myhostname X X X X
1719email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001720enabled X X X X
1721errorfile X X X X
1722errorloc X X X X
1723errorloc302 X X X X
1724-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1725errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001726force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001727fullconn X - X X
1728grace X X X X
1729hash-type X - X X
1730http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001731http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001732http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001733http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001734http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001735http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001736http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001737id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001738ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001739load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001740log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001741log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001742log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001743log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001744max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001745maxconn X X X -
1746mode X X X X
1747monitor fail - X X -
1748monitor-net X X X -
1749monitor-uri X X X -
1750option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1751option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1752option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1753option allbackups (*) X - X X
1754option checkcache (*) X - X X
1755option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1756option contstats (*) X X X -
1757option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1758option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1759option forceclose (*) X X X X
1760-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1761option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001762option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001763option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001764option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001765option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001766option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001767option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001768option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001769option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1770option httpchk X - X X
1771option httpclose (*) X X X X
1772option httplog X X X X
1773option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001774option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001775option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001776option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001777option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1778option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1779option logasap (*) X X X -
1780option mysql-check X - X X
1781option nolinger (*) X X X X
1782option originalto X X X X
1783option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001784option pgsql-check X - X X
1785option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001786option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001787option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001788option smtpchk X - X X
1789option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1790option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1791option splice-request (*) X X X X
1792option splice-response (*) X X X X
1793option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1794option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1795-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001796option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001797option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1798option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1799option tcpka X X X X
1800option tcplog X X X X
1801option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001802external-check command X - X X
1803external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001804persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1805rate-limit sessions X X X -
1806redirect - X X X
1807redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1808redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1809reqadd - X X X
1810reqallow - X X X
1811reqdel - X X X
1812reqdeny - X X X
1813reqiallow - X X X
1814reqidel - X X X
1815reqideny - X X X
1816reqipass - X X X
1817reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001818reqitarpit - X X X
1819reqpass - X X X
1820reqrep - X X X
1821-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001822reqtarpit - X X X
1823retries X - X X
1824rspadd - X X X
1825rspdel - X X X
1826rspdeny - X X X
1827rspidel - X X X
1828rspideny - X X X
1829rspirep - X X X
1830rsprep - X X X
1831server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001832server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001833source X - X X
1834srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001835stats admin - X X X
1836stats auth X X X X
1837stats enable X X X X
1838stats hide-version X X X X
1839stats http-request - X X X
1840stats realm X X X X
1841stats refresh X X X X
1842stats scope X X X X
1843stats show-desc X X X X
1844stats show-legends X X X X
1845stats show-node X X X X
1846stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001847-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1848stick match - - X X
1849stick on - - X X
1850stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001851stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001852stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001853tcp-check connect - - X X
1854tcp-check expect - - X X
1855tcp-check send - - X X
1856tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001857tcp-request connection - X X -
1858tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001859tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001860tcp-response content - - X X
1861tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001862timeout check X - X X
1863timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001864timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001865timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1866timeout connect X - X X
1867timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1868timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1869timeout http-request X X X X
1870timeout queue X - X X
1871timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001872timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001873timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1874timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001875timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001876transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001877unique-id-format X X X -
1878unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001879use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001880use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1882 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018854.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1886---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001887
1888This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1889
1890
1891acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1892 Declare or complete an access list.
1893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1894 no | yes | yes | yes
1895 Example:
1896 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1897 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1898 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001900 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901
1902
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001903appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1904 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001905 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1907 no | no | yes | yes
1908 Arguments :
1909 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1910 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1911
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001912 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001913 checked in each cookie value.
1914
1915 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1916 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1917 milliseconds.
1918
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001919 request-learn
1920 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1921 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1922 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1923 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1924 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1925 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1926
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001927 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1928 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1929 data following this prefix.
1930
1931 Example :
1932 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1933
1934 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1935 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1936
1937 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1938 2 modes are currently supported :
1939 - path-parameters :
1940 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1941 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1942 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1943 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1944 - query-string :
1945 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1946 query string.
1947
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001948 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1949 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1950 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001951
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001952 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1953 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954
1955
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001956backlog <conns>
1957 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1959 yes | yes | yes | no
1960 Arguments :
1961 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1962 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001963 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001964
1965 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1966 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1967 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1968 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1969 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1970 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1971 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1972 backlog parameter.
1973
1974 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1975 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1976 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1977
1978 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1979
1980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001982balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1985 yes | no | yes | yes
1986 Arguments :
1987 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1988 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1989 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1990 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1991
1992 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1993 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1994 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1995 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001996 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001997 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001998 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1999 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2000 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2001 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2002 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2003 it, so that you don't worry.
2004
2005 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2006 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2007 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2008 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2009 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2010 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2011 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2012 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002013
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002014 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2015 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2016 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2017 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2018 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2019 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2020 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2021 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2022
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002023 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002024 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002025 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2026 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002027 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002028 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2029 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2030 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2031 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2032 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002033 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2034 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2035 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2036 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2037 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2038 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2041 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2042 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2043 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2044 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2045 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2046 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2047 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002048 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002049 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002050 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2051 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2052 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002054 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2055 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2056 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2057 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2058 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2059 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2060 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2061 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2062 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2063 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2064 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2065 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002067 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002068 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2069 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2070 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2071 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2072 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2073 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2074 URIs start with a leading "/".
2075
2076 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2077 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2078 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2079 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2080
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002081 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002082 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2083
2084 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002085 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2086 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002087 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2088 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2089 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2090 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002091 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002092 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2093 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002094
2095 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2096 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2097 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2098 server will receive the request.
2099
2100 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2101 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2102 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2103 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2104 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002105 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2106 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2107 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002108
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002109 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2110 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2111 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2112 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2113 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002115 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002116 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2117 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2118 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2119
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002120 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2121 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2122 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2123
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002124 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002125 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002126 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2127 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2128 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2129 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2130 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2131 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002132 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002133 used instead.
2134
2135 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2136 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2137 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2138 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2139
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002140 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2141 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2142 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2143
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002144 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002147 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2148 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002149
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002150 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2151 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2152 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153
2154 Examples :
2155 balance roundrobin
2156 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002157 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002158 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2159 balance hdr(host)
2160 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002161
2162 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2163 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2164
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002165 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002166 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2167 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2168 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2169 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2170
2171 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2172 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2173 defaults to 16 kB.
2174
2175 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2176 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2177
2178 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2179 Round Robin.
2180
2181 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2182 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2183 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2184 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2185
2186 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2187
2188 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002189 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002190 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2191 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2192 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002194 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002195
2196
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002197bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2198bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2201 no | yes | yes | no
2202 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002203 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2204 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2205 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2206 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002207 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002208 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2209 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2210 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2211 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2212 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2213 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2214 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002215 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2216 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2217 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2218 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2219 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2220 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2221 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002222 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2223 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2224 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002225 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2226 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2227 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002228
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002229 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2230 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002231 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2232 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2233 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002234 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2235 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2236 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2237 the range.
2238
2239 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2240 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2241 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2242 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2243 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2244 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2245 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002246 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002247 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002248
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002249 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2250 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2251 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2252 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2253 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2254 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2255 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2256 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2257
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002258 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2259 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2260 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2261 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2264 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2265 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2266 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2267 in a frontend.
2268
2269 Example :
2270 listen http_proxy
2271 bind :80,:443
2272 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002273 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002275 listen http_https_proxy
2276 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002277 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002278
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002279 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2280 bind ipv6@:80
2281 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2282 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2283
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002284 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002285 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002286
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002287 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2288 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2289 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2290 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2291 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2292
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002293 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002294 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002295
2296
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002297bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002298 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2300 yes | yes | yes | yes
2301 Arguments :
2302 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2303 may be used to override a default value.
2304
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002305 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002306 option may be combined with other numbers.
2307
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002308 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002309 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2310 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2311 missing from all processes.
2312
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002313 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002314 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002315 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2316 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2317 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2318 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002319
2320 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2321 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2322 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2323 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2324 and 'even' instances.
2325
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002326 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2327 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2328 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2329 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002330
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002331 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2332 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2333
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002334 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2335 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2336 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2337
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002338 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2339 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2340
2341 Example :
2342 listen app_ip1
2343 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002344 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002345
2346 listen app_ip2
2347 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002348 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002349
2350 listen management
2351 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002352 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002353
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002354 listen management
2355 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2356 bind-process 1-4
2357
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002358 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002359
2360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361block { if | unless } <condition>
2362 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2364 no | yes | yes | yes
2365
2366 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2367 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002368 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002369 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002370 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2371 "block" statements per instance.
2372
2373 Example:
2374 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2375 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2376 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2377 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002379 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
2381
2382capture cookie <name> len <length>
2383 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2385 no | yes | yes | no
2386 Arguments :
2387 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2388 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2389 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2390 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2391 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2392
2393 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2394 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2395 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2396 right if it exceeds <length>.
2397
2398 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2399 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2400 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2401 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2402
2403 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2404 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2405 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2406
2407 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2408 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2409 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002410 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2411 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2412 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413
2414 Example:
2415 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2416
2417 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002418 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002419
2420
2421capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002422 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2424 no | yes | yes | no
2425 Arguments :
2426 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002427 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2429 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2430 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2431
2432 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2433 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2434 it exceeds <length>.
2435
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002436 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2438 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002439 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2440 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2441 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2442 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002443 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002444 environments to find where the request came from.
2445
2446 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2447 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2448 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2449 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002451 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2452 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2453 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2454 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2455 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002456
2457 Example:
2458 capture request header Host len 15
2459 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002460 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002462 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002463 about logging.
2464
2465
2466capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002467 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2469 no | yes | yes | no
2470 Arguments :
2471 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002472 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2474 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2475 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2476
2477 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2478 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2479 it exceeds <length>.
2480
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002481 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2483 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2484 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002485 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2486 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2487 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2488 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002490 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2491 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2492 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2493 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2494 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
2496 Example:
2497 capture response header Content-length len 9
2498 capture response header Location len 15
2499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002500 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002501 about logging.
2502
2503
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002504clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2507 yes | yes | yes | no
2508 Arguments :
2509 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2511 as explained at the top of this document.
2512
2513 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2514 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2515 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2516 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2517 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2518 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2519 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2520 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002521 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2523 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2524
2525 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2526 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2527 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2528 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2529 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2530 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2531
2532 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2533 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2534
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002535 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2536 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002538compression algo <algorithm> ...
2539compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002540compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002541 Enable HTTP compression.
2542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2543 yes | yes | yes | yes
2544 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002545 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2546 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2547 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2548
2549 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002550 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2551 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2552 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002553
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002554 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002555 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002556
2557 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2558 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2559 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2560 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2561 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002562 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002563
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002564 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2565 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2566 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2567 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2568 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2569 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2570 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002571 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002572
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002573 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002574 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002575 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2576 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2577 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2578 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2579 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002580
2581 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2582 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2583 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2584 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2585 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002586 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2587 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2588 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2589 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2590 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002591 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2592 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002593
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002594 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002595 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2596 "Accept-Encoding" header
2597 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002598 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002599 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2600 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002601 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2602 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2603 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2604 "multipart"
2605 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2606 header
2607 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2608 and later
2609 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2610 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002611
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002612 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2613 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002614
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002615 Examples :
2616 compression algo gzip
2617 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002619contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2622 yes | no | yes | yes
2623 Arguments :
2624 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2625 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2626 as explained at the top of this document.
2627
2628 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002629 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002630 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2632 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2633 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2634 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2635
2636 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2637 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2638 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2639 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2640 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2641 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2642
2643 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2644 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2645 instead.
2646
2647 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2648 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2649
2650
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002651cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002652 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2653 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002654 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 yes | no | yes | yes
2657 Arguments :
2658 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2659 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2660 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2661 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2662 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2663 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2664 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2665 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2666 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2667
2668 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2669 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2670 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2671 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2672 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2673 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002674 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2675 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2676 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2677 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2678 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002679
2680 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002681 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002682
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002683 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002684 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2685 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2686 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2687 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2688 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2689 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2690 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2691 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2692 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2693 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694
2695 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2696 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2697 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2698 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2699 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2700 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2701 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2702 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2703 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002704 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002705 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2706 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2707 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002708
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002709 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2710 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2711 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002712 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2713 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2714 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2715 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002716 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2717 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2718 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
2720 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2721 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2722 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2723 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2724 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2725 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2726 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2727 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2728 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2729
2730 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2731 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2732 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2733 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2734 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2735 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2736 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2737 persistence cookie in the cache.
2738 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2739
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002740 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2741 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2742 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2743 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2744 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2745 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2746 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2747 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2748 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2749 they logout.
2750
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002751 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2752 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2753 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2754 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2755
2756 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2757 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2758 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2759 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2760 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2761 this attribute.
2762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002763 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002764 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002765 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2766 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2767 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2768 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2769 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2770 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002771
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002772 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2773 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2774 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2775 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2776 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2777 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2778 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2779 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2780 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2781 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2782 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2783 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2784 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2785 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2786 the site.
2787
2788 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2789 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2790 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2791 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2792 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2793 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2794 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2795 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2796 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2797 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2798 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2799 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2800 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2801 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2802 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2803 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2806 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2807 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2808 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810 Examples :
2811 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2812 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2813 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002814 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002816 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002818
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002819declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2820 Declares a capture slot.
2821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2822 no | yes | yes | no
2823 Arguments:
2824 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2825
2826 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2827 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2828 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2829 for use in the response.
2830
2831 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002832 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002833 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2834
2835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002836default-server [param*]
2837 Change default options for a server in a backend
2838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2839 yes | no | yes | yes
2840 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002841 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2842 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2843 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2844 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002845
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002846 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002847 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2848
2849 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002850
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002852default_backend <backend>
2853 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2855 yes | yes | yes | no
2856 Arguments :
2857 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2858
2859 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2860 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2861 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2862 will catch all undetermined requests.
2863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864 Example :
2865
2866 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2867 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2868 default_backend dynamic
2869
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002870 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002873description <string>
2874 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2876 no | yes | yes | yes
2877 Arguments : string
2878
2879 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2880 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2881 it describes.
2882 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2883
2884
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885disabled
2886 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 yes | yes | yes | yes
2889 Arguments : none
2890
2891 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2892 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2893 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2894 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2895 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2896 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2897 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2898
2899 See also : "enabled"
2900
2901
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002902dispatch <address>:<port>
2903 Set a default server address
2904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2905 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002906 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002907
2908 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2909 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2910 during start-up.
2911
2912 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2913 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2914 possible with normal servers.
2915
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002916 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002917 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2918 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2919 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2920 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2921
2922 See also : "server"
2923
2924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925enabled
2926 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2928 yes | yes | yes | yes
2929 Arguments : none
2930
2931 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2932 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2933
2934 See also : "disabled"
2935
2936
2937errorfile <code> <file>
2938 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2940 yes | yes | yes | yes
2941 Arguments :
2942 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002943 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2944 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002945
2946 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002947 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002948 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002949 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2950 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
2952 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2953 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2954 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2955
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002956 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002958 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2959 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2960 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2961 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2962
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002963 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2964 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2965 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2966 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2967 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2968 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2971 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2972 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002973 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002974 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2975
2976 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2977
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002978 Example :
2979 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002980 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002981 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2982 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2983
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002984
2985errorloc <code> <url>
2986errorloc302 <code> <url>
2987 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2989 yes | yes | yes | yes
2990 Arguments :
2991 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002992 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002993
2994 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2995 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2996 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2997 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2998 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2999
3000 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3001 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3002 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3003
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003004 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3005
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003006 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3007 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3008 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3009 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003010 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003011 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3012 request.
3013
3014 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3015
3016
3017errorloc303 <code> <url>
3018 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3020 yes | yes | yes | yes
3021 Arguments :
3022 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3023 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3024
3025 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3026 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3027 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3028 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3029 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3030
3031 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3032 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3033 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3034
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003035 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3036
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003037 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3038 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3039 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3040 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003041 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003042
3043 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3044
3045
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003046email-alert from <emailaddr>
3047 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3048 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3049 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 yes | yes | yes | yes
3051
3052 Arguments :
3053
3054 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3055
3056 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3057 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3058
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003059 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003060 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3061 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003062
3063
3064email-alert level <level>
3065 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3066 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3068 yes | yes | yes | yes
3069
3070 Arguments :
3071
3072 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3073 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3074 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3075
3076 By default level is alert
3077
3078 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3079 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3080 for the proxy.
3081
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003082 Alerts are sent when :
3083
3084 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3085 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3086 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3087 is notice or lower
3088 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3089 and a health check status update occurs
3090
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003091 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3092 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003093 section 3.6 about mailers.
3094
3095
3096email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3097 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3098 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3099 yes | yes | yes | yes
3100
3101 Arguments :
3102
3103 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3104
3105 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3106 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3107
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003108 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3109 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003110
3111
3112email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3113 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3114 mailers.
3115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3116 yes | yes | yes | yes
3117
3118 Arguments :
3119
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003120 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003121
3122 By default the systems hostname is used.
3123
3124 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3125 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3126 for the proxy.
3127
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003128 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3129 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003130
3131
3132email-alert to <emailaddr>
3133 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3134 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3135 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3136 yes | yes | yes | yes
3137
3138 Arguments :
3139
3140 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3141
3142 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3143 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3144
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003145 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003146 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3147
3148
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003149force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3150 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3152 no | yes | yes | yes
3153
3154 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3155 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3156 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3157 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3158 marked down for maintenance operations.
3159
3160 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3161 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3162 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3163 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3164 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3165 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3166 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3167 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3168 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3169
3170 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3171 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3172 is used.
3173
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003174 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003175 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003176
3177
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003178fullconn <conns>
3179 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3181 yes | no | yes | yes
3182 Arguments :
3183 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3184 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3185
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003186 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003187 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003188 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003189 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3190 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3191 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3192 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3193 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003194 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003195
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003196 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3197 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003198 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3199 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3200 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003201
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003202 Example :
3203 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3204 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3205 # connections.
3206 backend dynamic
3207 fullconn 10000
3208 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3209 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3210
3211 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3212
3213
3214grace <time>
3215 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003217 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003218 Arguments :
3219 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3220 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3221 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3222
3223 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3224 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003225 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003226 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3227
3228 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3229 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3230 simplify it.
3231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003232
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003233hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003234 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3236 yes | no | yes | yes
3237 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003238 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3239 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003240
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003241 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3242 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3243 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3244 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3245 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3246 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3247 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3248 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3249 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3250 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003251
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003252 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3253 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3254 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3255 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3256 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3257 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3258 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3259 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3260 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3261 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3262 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3263 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3264 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003265 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3266 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003267
3268 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3269
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003270 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003271 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3272 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3273 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003274 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3275 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3276 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003277
3278 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3279 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003280 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3281 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3282 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3283 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3284
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003285 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3286 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3287 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3288 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3289 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3290 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3291 parameter.
3292
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003293 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3294 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3295 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3296 used on strings.
3297
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003298 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3299
3300 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3301 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3302 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3303 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3304 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3305 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3306 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3307 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3308 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3309 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3310 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3311 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003312
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003313 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3314 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3315 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003316
3317 See also : "balance", "server"
3318
3319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320http-check disable-on-404
3321 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003323 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003324 Arguments : none
3325
3326 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3327 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3328 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3329 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3330 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3331 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3332 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3333 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003334 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3335 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3336 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3337
3338 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3339
3340
3341http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003342 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003344 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003345 Arguments :
3346 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3347 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003348 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003349 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3350 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3351 details on the supported keywords.
3352
3353 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3354 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3355 with the usual backslash ('\').
3356
3357 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3358 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3359 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3360 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3361 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3362
3363 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003364 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003365 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3366 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3367 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3368
3369 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003370 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003371 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3372 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3373 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3374 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3375
3376 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003377 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003378 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3379 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3380 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3381 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3382 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3383 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3384 trace).
3385
3386 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003387 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003388 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3389 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3390 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3391 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3392 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3393 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3394
3395 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3396 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3397 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3398 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3399 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3400 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3401 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3402 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3403
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003404 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3405 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3406 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3407
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003408 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3409 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3410
3411 Examples :
3412 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003413 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003414
3415 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003416 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003417
3418 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003419 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003420
3421 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003422 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003424 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425
3426
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003427http-check send-state
3428 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | no | yes | yes
3431 Arguments : none
3432
3433 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3434 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3435 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3436 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3437 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3438
3439 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3440 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3441 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3442 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3443 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003444 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3445 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3446 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3447
3448 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3449 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3450 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3451
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003452 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3453 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3454 checked in multiple backends.
3455
3456 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3457 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3458
3459 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3460 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3461 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3462 one fails.
3463
3464 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3465 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3466 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3467
3468 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3469 server's queue.
3470
3471 Example of a header received by the application server :
3472 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3473 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3474
3475 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3476
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003477http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003478 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003479 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003480 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003481 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3482 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003483 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3484 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003485 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3486 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3487 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003488 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003489 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003490 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003491 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003492 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003493 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003494 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003496 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3497
3498 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3499 no | yes | yes | yes
3500
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003501 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3502 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3503 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3504 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3505 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003506
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003507 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3508 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3509 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3510
3511 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3512 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3513 are evaluated.
3514
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003515 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3516 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3517 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3518 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3519 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3520 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3521 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3522 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3523 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003524 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003525 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3526 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003527
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003528 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3529 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3530 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3531 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3532 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3533
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003534 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3535 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3536 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003537 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3538 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003539
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003540 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3541 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3542 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3543 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3544 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3545 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3546 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3547 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3548
3549 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3550 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3551 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003552 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3553 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003554
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003555 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3556 <name>.
3557
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003558 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3559 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3560 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3561 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3562 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3563 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3564 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3565 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3566
3567 Example:
3568
3569 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3570
3571 applied to:
3572
3573 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3574
3575 outputs:
3576
3577 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3578
3579 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3580
3581 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3582 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3583 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3584 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3585 header.
3586
3587 Example:
3588
3589 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3590
3591 applied to:
3592
3593 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3594
3595 outputs:
3596
3597 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3598
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003599 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3600 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3601 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3602 it.
3603
3604 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3605 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3606 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3607 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3608 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3609 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3610
3611 Example :
3612 # prepend the host name before the path
3613 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3614
3615 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3616 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3617 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3618 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3619 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3620 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3621 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3622 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3623
3624 Example :
3625 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3626 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3627
3628 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3629 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3630 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3631 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3632 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3633 "set-query".
3634
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003635 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3636 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3637 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3638 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3639 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3640 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3641 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3642 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3643
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003644 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3645 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3646 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3647 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3648 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3649 another equipment.
3650
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003651 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3652 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3653 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3654 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3655 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3656 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3657 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3658 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3659
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003660 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3661 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3662 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3663 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3664 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3665 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3666 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3667 admin privileges.
3668
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003669 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3670 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3671 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3672 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3673 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3674 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3675 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3676 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3677
3678 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3679 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3680 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3681 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3682 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3683 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3684
3685 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3686 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3687 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3688 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3689 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3690 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3691
3692 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3693 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3694 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3695 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3696 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3697 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3698 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3699 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3700 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3701
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003702 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003703 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3704 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3705 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3706 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3707 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3708 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3709 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3710 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3711 request header" for more information.
3712
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003713 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3714 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3715 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3716 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003717 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3718 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003719
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003720 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3721 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3722 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3723 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3724 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3725 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3726 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3727 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3728 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3729 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3730 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3731 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3732
3733 These actions take one or two arguments :
3734 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3735 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3736 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3737 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3738
3739 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3740 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3741 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3742 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3743
3744 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3745 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3746 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3747 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3748 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3749 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3750 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3751 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3752
3753 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3754 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3755 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3756 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3757 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3758
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003759 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3760 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3761 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3762 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3763 continues.
3764
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003765 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3766 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3767 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3768 the actions evaluation continues.
3769
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003770 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3771 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3772 inline.
3773
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003774 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3775 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3776 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3777 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003778 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003779 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003780 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003781 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3782 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003783 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003784 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003785 and '_'.
3786
3787 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3788 followed by some converters.
3789
3790 Example:
3791
3792 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3793
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003794 - set-src <expr> :
3795 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3796 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3797 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3798 source IP for privacy.
3799
3800 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3801 followed by some converters.
3802
3803 Example:
3804
3805 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3806 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3807
3808 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3809
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003810 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3811 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3812 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3813 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3814 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3815 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3816 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3817 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3818 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3819 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3820 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3821 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3822 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3823 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3824 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3825 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3826
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003827 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3828
3829 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3830 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003831 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3832 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3833
3834 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3835 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3836 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3837 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003838
3839 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003840 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3841 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3842 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003843
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003844 http-request allow if nagios
3845 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3846 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3847 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003848
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003849 Example:
3850 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003851 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003852
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003853 Example:
3854 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3855 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003856 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003857 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3858 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3859 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3860 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3861 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3862 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3863
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003864 Example:
3865 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3866 acl add path /addacl
3867 acl del path /delacl
3868
3869 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3870
3871 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3872 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3873
3874 Example:
3875 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3876 acl setmap path /setmap
3877 acl delmap path /delmap
3878
3879 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3880
3881 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3882 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3883
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003884 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3885 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003886
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003887http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003888 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003889 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003890 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3891 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003892 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003893 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3894 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3895 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3896 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003897 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003898 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003899 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003900 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003901 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003902 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003903 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003904 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3905
3906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3907 no | yes | yes | yes
3908
3909 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3910 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3911 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3912 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3913 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3914 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3915
3916 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3917 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3918 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3919 current section.
3920
3921 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3922 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3923 rules are evaluated.
3924
3925 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3926 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3927 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3928 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3929 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3930 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3931 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3932
3933 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3934 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3935 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3936 external users.
3937
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003938 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3939 <name>.
3940
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003941 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3942 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3943 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3944 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3945 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3946 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3947 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3948 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3949
3950 Example:
3951
3952 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3953
3954 applied to:
3955
3956 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3957
3958 outputs:
3959
3960 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3961
3962 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3963
3964 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3965 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3966 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3967 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3968 header.
3969
3970 Example:
3971
3972 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3973
3974 applied to:
3975
3976 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3977
3978 outputs:
3979
3980 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3981
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003982 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
3983 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
3984 adapted to the new code.
3985
3986 Example:
3987
3988 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
3989 http-response set-status 431
3990
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003991 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3992 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3993 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3994 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3995 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3996 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3997 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3998 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3999
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004000 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4001 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4002 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4003 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4004 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4005 another equipment.
4006
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004007 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4008 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4009 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4010 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4011 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4012 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4013 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4014 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4015
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004016 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4017 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4018 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4019 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4020 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4021 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4022 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4023 admin privileges.
4024
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004025 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4026 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4027 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4028 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4029 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4030 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4031 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4032 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4033
4034 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4035 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4036 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4037 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4038 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4039 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4040
4041 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4042 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4043 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4044 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4045 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4046 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4047
4048 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4049 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4050 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4051 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4052 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4053 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4054 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4055 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4056 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4057
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004058 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4059 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4060 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4061 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4062 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4063 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4064 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4065 response header" for more information.
4066
4067 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4068 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4069 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4070 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4071 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004072 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4073 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004074
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004075 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4076 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4077 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4078 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4079 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4080 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4081
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004082 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4083 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4084 inline.
4085
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004086 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4087 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4088 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4089 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004090 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004091 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004092 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004093 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4094 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004095 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004096 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004097 and '_'.
4098
4099 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4100 followed by some converters.
4101
4102 Example:
4103
4104 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4105
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004106 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4107 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4108 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4109 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4110 continues.
4111
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004112 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4113 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4114 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4115 the actions evaluation continues.
4116
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004117 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4118 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4119 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4120 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4121 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4122 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4123 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4124 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4125 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4126 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4127 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4128 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4129 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4130 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4131 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4132 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4133
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004134 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4135
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004136 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004137 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4138 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004139 rules.
4140
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004141 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4142 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4143 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4144 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4145
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004146 Example:
4147 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4148
4149 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4150
4151 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4152 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4153
4154 Example:
4155 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4156
4157 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4158
4159 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4160 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4161
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004162 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4163 ACL usage.
4164
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004165
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004166http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4167 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4168
4169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | no | yes | yes
4171
4172 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4173 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4174 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4175 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4176 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4177 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4178
4179 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4180
4181 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4182 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4183 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4184 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4185 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4186 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4187 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4188 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4189 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4190 not checking any request past the first one.
4191
4192 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4193 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4194 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4195 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4196 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4197 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4198 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4199
4200 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4201 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4202 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4203 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4204 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4205 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4206 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4207 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4208 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4209 downsides of rare connection failures.
4210
4211 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4212 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4213 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4214 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4215 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4216 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4217 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4218 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4219 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4220 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4221 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4222 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4223
4224 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4225 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4226 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4227 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4228
4229 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4230 and are never shared ;
4231
4232 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4233 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4234 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4235 and are never shared ;
4236
4237 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4238 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4239 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4240
4241 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4242 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4243 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4244
4245 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4246
4247
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004248http-send-name-header [<header>]
4249 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4250
4251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 yes | no | yes | yes
4253
4254 Arguments :
4255
4256 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4257
4258 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4259 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4260 is added with the header string proved.
4261
4262 See also : "server"
4263
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004264id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004265 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 no | yes | yes | yes
4268 Arguments : none
4269
4270 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4271 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4272 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004273
4274
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004275ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4276 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4278 no | yes | yes | yes
4279
4280 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4281 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4282 and running).
4283
4284 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4285 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4286 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004287 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004288 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4289
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004290 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4291 "unless" condition is met.
4292
4293 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4294
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004295load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4296 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4297 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4298 yes | no | yes | yes
4299
4300 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4301 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4302 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4303 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4304 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4305 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4306 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4307 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4308
4309 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4310 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004311 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004312
4313 Arguments:
4314 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4315 named "server-state-file".
4316
4317 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4318 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4319 name is used as a file name.
4320
4321 none don't load any stat for this backend
4322
4323 Notes:
4324 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4325 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4326 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4327
4328 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4329 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4330
4331 Example 1:
4332
4333 Minimal configuration:
4334
4335 global
4336 stats socket /tmp/socket
4337 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4338
4339 defaults
4340 load-server-state-from-file global
4341
4342 backend bk
4343 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4344 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4345
4346 Then one can run :
4347
4348 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4349
4350 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4351
4352 1
4353 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4354 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4355 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4356
4357 Example 2:
4358
4359 Minimal configuration:
4360
4361 global
4362 stats socket /tmp/socket
4363 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4364
4365 defaults
4366 load-server-state-from-file local
4367
4368 backend bk
4369 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4370 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4371
4372 Then one can run :
4373
4374 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4375
4376 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4377
4378 1
4379 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4380 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4381 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4382
4383 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4384 "show servers state"
4385
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004386
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004387log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004388log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004389no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004390 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004393
4394 Prefix :
4395 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4396 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4397 prefix does not allow arguments.
4398
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004399 Arguments :
4400 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4401 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4402 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4403 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4404 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4405 parameter.
4406
4407 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4408 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4409
4410 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4411 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4412 standard syslog port).
4413
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004414 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4415 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4416 standard syslog port).
4417
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004418 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4419 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4420 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4421 appropriately writeable).
4422
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004423 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4424 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004425
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004426 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4427 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4428 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4429 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4430 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4431 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4432 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4433 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4434 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4435 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4436 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4437
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004438 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4439
4440 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4441 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4442 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4443
4444 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4445 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4446 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004447 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4448 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4449 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4450 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4451 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004452
4453 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4454
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004455 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4456 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4457 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004458
4459 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4460 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4461 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4462 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4463
4464 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4465 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004466
4467 Example :
4468 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004469 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4470 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004471 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004472
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004473
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004474log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004475 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4476 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4477 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004478
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004479 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4480 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4481 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4482 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4483 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004484
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004485log-format-sd <string>
4486 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4487 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 yes | yes | yes | no
4489
4490 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4491 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4492 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4493 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4494 which covers the log format string in depth.
4495
4496 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4497 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4498
4499 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4500 log format to "rfc5424".
4501
4502 Example :
4503 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4504
4505
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004506log-tag <string>
4507 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4509 yes | yes | yes | yes
4510
4511 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4512 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4513 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4514 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4515 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4516 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4517 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4518 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4519 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004520
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004521max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4522 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4523 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4524 yes | no | yes | yes
4525
4526 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4527 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4528 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4529 servers.
4530
4531 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4532 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4533 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4534 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4535 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4536 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4537 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4538 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4539 picking a different server.
4540
4541 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4542 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4543 even if they have to be queued.
4544
4545 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4546 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4547
4548
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004549maxconn <conns>
4550 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4552 yes | yes | yes | no
4553 Arguments :
4554 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4555 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4556 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4557 closes.
4558
4559 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4560 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4561 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4562 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004563 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4564 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4565 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4566 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004567
4568 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4569 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4570 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4571
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004572 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4573
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004574 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4575
4576
4577mode { tcp|http|health }
4578 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 yes | yes | yes | yes
4581 Arguments :
4582 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4583 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4584 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4585 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4586
4587 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4588 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4589 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4590 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4591 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4592
4593 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004594 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4595 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4596 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4597 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4598 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4599 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4600 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004601
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004602 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4603 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4604 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004605
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004606 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004607 defaults http_instances
4608 mode http
4609
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004610 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004612
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004613monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004614 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4616 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004617 Arguments :
4618 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4619 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004620 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004621 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4622 backend and its backup.
4623
4624 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4625 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4626 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4627 servers in a list of backends.
4628
4629 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4630 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4631 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4632 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4633 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4634 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4635 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004636 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4637 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004638
4639 Example:
4640 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004641 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004642 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4643 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4644 monitor-uri /site_alive
4645 monitor fail if site_dead
4646
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004647 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004648
4649
4650monitor-net <source>
4651 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 yes | yes | yes | no
4654 Arguments :
4655 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4656 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4657 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4658 followed by a mask.
4659
4660 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4661 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004662 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004663 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4664
4665 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4666 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4667 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4668 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004669 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4670 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4671 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004672
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004673 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4674 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4675 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4676 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4677 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4678 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004679
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004680 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4681 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004682
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004683 Example :
4684 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4685 frontend www
4686 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4687
4688 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4689
4690
4691monitor-uri <uri>
4692 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | yes | yes | no
4695 Arguments :
4696 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4697 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4698
4699 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4700 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4701 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4702 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4703 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4704 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4705 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4706 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4707
4708 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4709 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4710 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4711 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4712 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4713 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4714
4715 Example :
4716 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4717 frontend www
4718 mode http
4719 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4720
4721 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004723
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004724option abortonclose
4725no option abortonclose
4726 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 yes | no | yes | yes
4729 Arguments : none
4730
4731 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4732 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4733 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4734 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004735 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004736 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4737 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4738 encountered while delivering the response.
4739
4740 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4741 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4742 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4743 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4744 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4745 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004746 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004747 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004748 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004749 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4750 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4751 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4752
4753 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4754 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4755 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4756 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4757 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4758 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4759 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4760 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004761 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004762
4763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4765
4766 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4767
4768
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004769option accept-invalid-http-request
4770no option accept-invalid-http-request
4771 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | yes | yes | no
4774 Arguments : none
4775
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004776 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004777 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4778 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4779 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4780 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4781 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4782 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4783 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004784 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4785 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4786 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4787 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4788 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004789 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004790 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4791 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4792 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004793
4794 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4795 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4796 been confirmed.
4797
4798 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4799 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004800 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4801 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004802 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4803
4804 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4805 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4806
4807 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4808 stats socket.
4809
4810
4811option accept-invalid-http-response
4812no option accept-invalid-http-response
4813 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4815 yes | no | yes | yes
4816 Arguments : none
4817
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004818 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004819 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4820 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4821 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4822 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4823 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4824 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4825 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004826 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4827 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4828 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004829
4830 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4831 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4832 been confirmed.
4833
4834 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4835 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4836 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4837 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4838
4839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4841
4842 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4843 stats socket.
4844
4845
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004846option allbackups
4847no option allbackups
4848 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4850 yes | no | yes | yes
4851 Arguments : none
4852
4853 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4854 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4855 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4856 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4857 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4858 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4859 order between the backup servers anymore.
4860
4861 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4862 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4863
4864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4866
4867
4868option checkcache
4869no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004870 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4872 yes | no | yes | yes
4873 Arguments : none
4874
4875 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4876 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004877 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004878 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4879 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004880 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004881
4882 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004883 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004884 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004885 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4886 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004887 to the client are :
4888 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004889 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004890 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004891 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4892 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4893 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4894 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4895 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4896 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4897 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4898 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4899 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4900 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4901 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4902
4903 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004904 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004905 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004906 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004907 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4908
4909 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4910 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004911 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004912 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4913
4914 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4915 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4916
4917
4918option clitcpka
4919no option clitcpka
4920 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4922 yes | yes | yes | no
4923 Arguments : none
4924
4925 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4926 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4927 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4928 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4929
4930 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4931 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4932 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4933 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4934
4935 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4936 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4937 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4938 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4939 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4940
4941 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4942
4943 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4944 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4945 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4946
4947 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4948 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4949
4950 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4951
4952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004953option contstats
4954 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4956 yes | yes | yes | no
4957 Arguments : none
4958
4959 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4960 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4961 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4962 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4963 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4964 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4965 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4966
4967
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004968option dontlog-normal
4969no option dontlog-normal
4970 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | yes | yes | no
4973 Arguments : none
4974
4975 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4976 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4977 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4978 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4979 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4980 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4981 logged.
4982
4983 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4984 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4985 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004987 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004988 logging.
4989
4990
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004991option dontlognull
4992no option dontlognull
4993 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4995 yes | yes | yes | no
4996 Arguments : none
4997
4998 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4999 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5000 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5001 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5002 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5003 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005004 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5005 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5006 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005007
5008 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5009 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5010 would not be logged.
5011
5012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5014
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005015 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5016 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005017
5018
5019option forceclose
5020no option forceclose
5021 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005023 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005024 Arguments : none
5025
5026 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5027 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5028 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5029 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5030 global session times in the logs.
5031
5032 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005033 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005034 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005035
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005036 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5037 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5038 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5039
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005040 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5041 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005042
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005043 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5044 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5045
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005046 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005047
5048
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005049option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005050 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5052 yes | yes | yes | yes
5053 Arguments :
5054 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5055 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005056 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005057 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005058
5059 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5060 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5061 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5062 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5063 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5064 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5065 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005066 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5067 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5068 possible that the client has already brought one.
5069
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005070 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005071 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005072 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5073 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005074 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5075 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005076
5077 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5078 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5079 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5080 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5081 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5082 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5083 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5084
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005085 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5086 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5087 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5088 are under the control of the end-user.
5089
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005090 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005091 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5092 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005093 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5094 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5095 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005096
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005097 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005098 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5099 frontend www
5100 mode http
5101 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5102
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005103 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5104 backend www
5105 mode http
5106 option forwardfor header X-Client
5107
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005108 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005109 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005110
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005111
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005112option http-buffer-request
5113no option http-buffer-request
5114 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | yes | yes | yes
5117 Arguments : none
5118
5119 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5120 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5121 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5122 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5123 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5124 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5125 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5126 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5127 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5128 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5129 default.
5130
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005131 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005132
5133
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005134option http-ignore-probes
5135no option http-ignore-probes
5136 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 yes | yes | yes | no
5139 Arguments : none
5140
5141 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5142 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5143 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5144 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5145 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5146 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5147 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5148 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5149 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5150 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5151 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5152 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5153
5154 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5155 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5156 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5157 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5158 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5159 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5160 are often the only way to detect them.
5161
5162 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5163 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5164
5165 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5166
5167
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005168option http-keep-alive
5169no option http-keep-alive
5170 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5172 yes | yes | yes | yes
5173 Arguments : none
5174
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005175 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5176 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5177 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5178 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5179 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5180 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5181 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5182
5183 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5184 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005185 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5186 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5187 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5188 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5189 situations where this option may be useful :
5190
5191 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5192 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5193
5194 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5195 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5196
5197 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5198 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5199 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5200 request.
5201
5202 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5203 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005204 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5205 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5206 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005207
5208 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5209 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5210
5211 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5212 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5213 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5214 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5215 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5216 not set.
5217
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005218 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5219 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005220 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005221 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005222
5223 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005224 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5225 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005226
5227
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005228option http-no-delay
5229no option http-no-delay
5230 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 yes | yes | yes | yes
5233 Arguments : none
5234
5235 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5236 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5237 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5238 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5239 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5240 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5241 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5242 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5243 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5244 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5245 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5246 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5247 affected.
5248
5249 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5250 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5251 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5252 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5253 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5254 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5255 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5256 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5257 latency environments.
5258
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005259 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5260
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005261
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005262option http-pretend-keepalive
5263no option http-pretend-keepalive
5264 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 yes | yes | yes | yes
5267 Arguments : none
5268
5269 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5270 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5271 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5272 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5273 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5274 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5275 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5276 consider the response complete.
5277
5278 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5279 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5280 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5281 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5282 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5283 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5284
5285 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5286 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5287 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5288 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5289 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5290 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5291 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5292
5293 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5294 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005295 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005296 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5297 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005298
5299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5301
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005302 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5303 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005304
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005305
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005306option http-server-close
5307no option http-server-close
5308 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5310 yes | yes | yes | yes
5311 Arguments : none
5312
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005313 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5314 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5315 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5316 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5317 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5318 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5319 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5320 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5321 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5322 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5323 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5324 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5325 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5326 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5327 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5328 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005329
5330 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5331 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5332 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5333 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005334 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5335 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005336
5337 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5338 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005339 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5340 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005341 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5342 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005343
5344 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5345 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5346
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005347 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005348 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5349 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005350
5351
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005352option http-tunnel
5353no option http-tunnel
5354 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5356 yes | yes | yes | yes
5357 Arguments : none
5358
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005359 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5360 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5361 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5362 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5363 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5364 "option http-tunnel".
5365
5366 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005367 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005368 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5369 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5370 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5371 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5372 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5373 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5374 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005375
5376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5378
5379 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5380 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5381 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5382
5383
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005384option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005385no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005386 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5388 yes | yes | yes | no
5389 Arguments : none
5390
5391 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5392 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5393 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5394 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5395 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5396 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5397 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5398
5399 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5400 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005401 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5402 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5403 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005404
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005405 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5406 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5407 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5408 front of an existing proxy.
5409
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005410 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5411
5412 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5413 http-server-close".
5414
5415
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005416option httpchk
5417option httpchk <uri>
5418option httpchk <method> <uri>
5419option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5420 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5422 yes | no | yes | yes
5423 Arguments :
5424 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5425 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5426 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5427 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5428 ones.
5429
5430 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5431 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5432 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5433
5434 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5435 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5436 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5437 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5438 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5439
5440 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5441 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5442 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5443 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5444 the lack of any response.
5445
5446 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5447
5448 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5449 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5450 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5451
5452 Examples :
5453 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5454 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5455 backend https_relay
5456 mode tcp
5457 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5458 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5459
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005460 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5461 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5462 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005463
5464
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005465option httpclose
5466no option httpclose
5467 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5469 yes | yes | yes | yes
5470 Arguments : none
5471
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005472 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5473 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5474 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5475 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005476 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005477 "option http-tunnel".
5478
5479 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5480 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5481 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5482 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5483 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5484 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5485 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5486 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005487
5488 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005489 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005490 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5491 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5492 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5493 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5494 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005495
5496 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5497 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005498 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5499 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005500 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5501 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005502
5503 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5504 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5505
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005506 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5507 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005508
5509
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005510option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005511 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5513 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005514 Arguments :
5515 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5516 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5517 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5518 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5519 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005520
5521 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5522 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5523 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5524 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5525 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5526 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5527 ports.
5528
5529 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5530
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005531 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5532 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005534 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005535
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005536
5537option http_proxy
5538no option http_proxy
5539 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5541 yes | yes | yes | yes
5542 Arguments : none
5543
5544 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5545 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5546 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5547 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5548 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5549
5550 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5551 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005552 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5553 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005554
5555 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5556 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5557
5558 Example :
5559 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5560 backend direct_forward
5561 option httpclose
5562 option http_proxy
5563
5564 See also : "option httpclose"
5565
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005566
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005567option independent-streams
5568no option independent-streams
5569 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | yes | yes | yes
5572 Arguments : none
5573
5574 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5575 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5576 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5577 receive data or not.
5578
5579 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5580 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5581 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5582 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5583 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5584 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5585 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5586 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5587 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5588 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5589 socket buffers.
5590
5591 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5592 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5593 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5594 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5595 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5596
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005597 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005598 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5599 deprecated.
5600
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005601 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005602
5603
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005604option ldap-check
5605 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 yes | no | yes | yes
5608 Arguments : none
5609
5610 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5611 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5612 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5613 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5614
5615 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5616 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5617
5618 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5619 configure it.
5620
5621 Example :
5622 option ldap-check
5623
5624 See also : "option httpchk"
5625
5626
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005627option external-check
5628 Use external processes for server health checks
5629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5630 yes | no | yes | yes
5631
5632 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5633 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5634 command".
5635
5636 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5637
5638 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5639
5640
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005641option log-health-checks
5642no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005643 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 yes | no | yes | yes
5646 Arguments : none
5647
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005648 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5649 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5650 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005651
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005652 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5653 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5654 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5655 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5656 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5657
5658 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5659 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005660
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005661 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5662 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5663 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005664
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005665
5666option log-separate-errors
5667no option log-separate-errors
5668 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5670 yes | yes | yes | no
5671 Arguments : none
5672
5673 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5674 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5675 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5676 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5677 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5678 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5679 provides very important information.
5680
5681 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5682 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5683 error logs.
5684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005685 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005686 logging.
5687
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005688
5689option logasap
5690no option logasap
5691 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5693 yes | yes | yes | no
5694 Arguments : none
5695
5696 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5697 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5698 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5699 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5700 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5701 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5702 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005703 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005704 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5705 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5706
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005707 Examples :
5708 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5709 mode http
5710 option httplog
5711 option logasap
5712 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5713
5714 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5715 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5716 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5717 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005719 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005720 logging.
5721
5722
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005723option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005724 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005727 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005728 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5729 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005730 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005731
5732 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5733 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5734 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5735 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5736 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5737 in the MySQL table, like this :
5738
5739 USE mysql;
5740 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5741 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5742
5743 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5744 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5745 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5746 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5747 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5748 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5749 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5750 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5751 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5752
5753 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5754 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005755
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005756 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005757
5758 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5759 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5760 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5761 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005762 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5763 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005764
5765 See also: "option httpchk"
5766
5767
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005768option nolinger
5769no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005770 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5772 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005773 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005774
5775 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5776 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5777 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5778 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5779 connections.
5780
5781 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5782 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5783 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5784 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5785 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5786 this too.
5787
5788 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5789 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5790 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5791
5792 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5793 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5794 for servers.
5795
5796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5798
5799
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005800option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5801 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 yes | yes | yes | yes
5804 Arguments :
5805 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5806 matching <network>
5807 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5808 header name.
5809
5810 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5811 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5812 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5813 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5814 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5815 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5816 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5817 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5818 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5819 possible that the client has already brought one.
5820
5821 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5822 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5823 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5824 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5825 header and requires different one.
5826
5827 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5828 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5829 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5830 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5831 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5832 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5833 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5834
5835 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5836 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5837 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5838 both are defined.
5839
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005840 Examples :
5841 # Original Destination address
5842 frontend www
5843 mode http
5844 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5845
5846 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5847 backend www
5848 mode http
5849 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5850
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005851 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5852 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005853
5854
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005855option persist
5856no option persist
5857 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5859 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005860 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005861
5862 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5863 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5864 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5865 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5866 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5867 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5868 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5869 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5870 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5871 redirected to another valid server.
5872
5873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5875
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005876 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005877
5878
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005879option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5880 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5882 yes | no | yes | yes
5883 Arguments :
5884 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5885 PostgreSQL server.
5886
5887 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5888 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5889 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5890 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5891
5892 See also: "option httpchk"
5893
5894
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005895option prefer-last-server
5896no option prefer-last-server
5897 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5898 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | no | yes | yes
5900 Arguments : none
5901
5902 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5903 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5904 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5905 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5906 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5907 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5908 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5909 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5910 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005911 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5912 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5913 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5914 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5915 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5916 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5917 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005918
5919 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5920 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5921
5922 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5923
5924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005925option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005926option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005927no option redispatch
5928 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5930 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005931 Arguments :
5932 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5933 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5934 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5935 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5936 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5937 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5938 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5939 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5940 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005942
5943 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5944 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5945 be able to access the service anymore.
5946
5947 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5948 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5949
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005950 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005951 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5952 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005954 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5955 "redisp" keywords.
5956
5957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5959
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005960 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005961
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005962
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005963option redis-check
5964 Use redis health checks for server testing
5965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5966 yes | no | yes | yes
5967 Arguments : none
5968
5969 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5970 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5971 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5972 find the "+PONG" response message.
5973
5974 Example :
5975 option redis-check
5976
5977 See also : "option httpchk"
5978
5979
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005980option smtpchk
5981option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5982 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5984 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005985 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005986 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5987 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5988 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5989
5990 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5991 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5992 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5993
5994 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5995 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5996 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5997 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5998 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5999 dead server.
6000
6001 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6002 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6003 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6004 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6005
6006 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6007 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6008 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6009 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006010 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006011
6012 Example :
6013 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6014
6015 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006018option socket-stats
6019no option socket-stats
6020
6021 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6023 yes | yes | yes | no
6024
6025 Arguments : none
6026
6027
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006028option splice-auto
6029no option splice-auto
6030 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6032 yes | yes | yes | yes
6033 Arguments : none
6034
6035 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6036 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6037 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6038 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006039 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006040 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6041 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6042 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6043 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6044
6045 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6046 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6047 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6048 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6049 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6050 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6051 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6052 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6053 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6054 keyword.
6055
6056 Example :
6057 option splice-auto
6058
6059 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6060 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6061
6062 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6063 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6064
6065
6066option splice-request
6067no option splice-request
6068 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6070 yes | yes | yes | yes
6071 Arguments : none
6072
6073 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006074 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006075 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6076 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6077 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6078 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6079
6080 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6081
6082 Example :
6083 option splice-request
6084
6085 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6086 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6087
6088 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6089 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6090
6091
6092option splice-response
6093no option splice-response
6094 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6096 yes | yes | yes | yes
6097 Arguments : none
6098
6099 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006100 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006101 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6102 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6103 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6104 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6105
6106 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6107
6108 Example :
6109 option splice-response
6110
6111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6113
6114 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6115 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6116
6117
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006118option srvtcpka
6119no option srvtcpka
6120 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6122 yes | no | yes | yes
6123 Arguments : none
6124
6125 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6126 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6127 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6128 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6129
6130 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6131 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6132 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6133 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6134
6135 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6136 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6137 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6138 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6139 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6140
6141 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6142
6143 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6144 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6145 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6146
6147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6149
6150 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6151
6152
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006153option ssl-hello-chk
6154 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6156 yes | no | yes | yes
6157 Arguments : none
6158
6159 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6160 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6161 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6162 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6163 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6164 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6165 hello message.
6166
6167 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6168 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6169 messages, which is appreciable.
6170
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006171 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6172 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6173 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006174
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006175 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6176
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006177
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006178option tcp-check
6179 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6181 yes | no | yes | yes
6182
6183 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6184 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6185
6186 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6187 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6188 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6189
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006190 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006191 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6192 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6193 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6194 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6195 only.
6196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006197 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006198 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6199 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6200 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6201 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6202
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006203 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006204 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6205 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006206 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006207 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6208 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6209 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6210 the respective protocols.
6211 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6212 analysed.
6213
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006214 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6215 script.
6216
6217 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6218 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6219 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6220 The "comment" is of course optional.
6221
6222
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006223 Examples :
6224 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6225 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006226 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006227
6228 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6229 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006230 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006231
6232 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6233 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006234 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006235 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006236 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006237 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006238 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006239 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006240 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6241 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006242 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006243 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6244 tcp-check expect string +OK
6245
6246 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6247 (send many headers before analyzing)
6248 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006249 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006250 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6251 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6252 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6253 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006254 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006255
6256
6257 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6258
6259
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006260option tcp-smart-accept
6261no option tcp-smart-accept
6262 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6264 yes | yes | yes | no
6265 Arguments : none
6266
6267 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6268 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6269 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6270 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6271 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6272 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6273
6274 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6275 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6276 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6277 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6278
6279 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6280 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6281 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6282 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6283
6284 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6285 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6286 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6287
6288 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6289 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6290 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6291
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006292 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6293
6294
6295option tcp-smart-connect
6296no option tcp-smart-connect
6297 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6299 yes | no | yes | yes
6300 Arguments : none
6301
6302 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6303 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6304 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6305 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6306 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6307
6308 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6309 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6310 complex.
6311
6312 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6313 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6314 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6315
6316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6318
6319 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6320
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006321
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006322option tcpka
6323 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 yes | yes | yes | yes
6326 Arguments : none
6327
6328 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6329 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6330 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6331 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6332
6333 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6334 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6335 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6336 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6337
6338 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6339 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6340 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6341 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6342 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6343
6344 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6345
6346 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6347 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6348 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6349 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6350 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6351 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6352 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6353 backends.
6354
6355 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6356
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006357
6358option tcplog
6359 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6361 yes | yes | yes | yes
6362 Arguments : none
6363
6364 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6365 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6366 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6367 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6368 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6369 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6370 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6371 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6372
6373 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006375 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006376
6377
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006378option transparent
6379no option transparent
6380 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006382 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006383 Arguments : none
6384
6385 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6386 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6387 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6388 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6389 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6390 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6391 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6392 appropriate server.
6393
6394 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6395 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6396
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006397 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006398 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006399
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006400
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006401external-check command <command>
6402 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6404 yes | no | yes | yes
6405
6406 Arguments :
6407 <command> is the external command to run
6408
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006409 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6410
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006411 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006412
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006413 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6414 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6415 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6416 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6417 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6418 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006419
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006420 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6421
6422 Environment variables :
6423 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6424 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6425
6426 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6427
6428 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6429
6430 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6431 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6432 for a UNIX socket).
6433
6434 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6435
6436 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6437
6438 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6439
6440 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6441
6442 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6443
6444 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6445 socket).
6446
6447 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6448 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6449
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006450 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6451 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6452 failed.
6453
6454 Example :
6455 external-check command /bin/true
6456
6457 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6458
6459
6460external-check path <path>
6461 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6463 yes | no | yes | yes
6464
6465 Arguments :
6466 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6467
6468 The default path is "".
6469
6470 Example :
6471 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6472
6473 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6474 "external-check command"
6475
6476
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006477persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006478persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006479 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6481 yes | no | yes | yes
6482 Arguments :
6483 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006484 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6485 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006486
6487 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6488 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6489 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6490 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6491 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6492 forwarded to this server.
6493
6494 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6495 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6496 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006497 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006498 a single "listen" section.
6499
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006500 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6501 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6502 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6503
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006504 Example :
6505 listen tse-farm
6506 bind :3389
6507 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6508 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6509 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6510 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6511 persist rdp-cookie
6512 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006513 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006514 balance rdp-cookie
6515 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6516 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6517
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006518 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6519 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006520
6521
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006522rate-limit sessions <rate>
6523 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6525 yes | yes | yes | no
6526 Arguments :
6527 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6528 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6529
6530 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6531 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6532 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6533 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6534 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6535 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6536
6537 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6538 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6539 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6540 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6541
6542 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6543 listen smtp
6544 mode tcp
6545 bind :25
6546 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006547 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006548
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006549 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6550 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6551 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006552
6553 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6554
6555
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006556redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6557redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6558redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006559 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6561 no | yes | yes | yes
6562
6563 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006564 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006565
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006566 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006567 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006568 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6569 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6570 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006571
6572 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6573 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6574 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6575 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6576 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006577 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6578 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6579 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6580 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006581
6582 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6583 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6584 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6585 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6586 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6587 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006588 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006589 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006590 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6591 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6592 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006593
6594 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006595 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6596 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6597 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006598 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006599 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6600 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6601 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6602 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006603
6604 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6605 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6606
6607 - "drop-query"
6608 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6609 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6610 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6611 with a location-type redirect.
6612
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006613 - "append-slash"
6614 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6615 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6616 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6617 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6618
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006619 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6620 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6621 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6622 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6623 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6624 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6625 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6626
6627 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6628 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6629 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6630 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6631 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6632 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6633 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006634
6635 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6636 acl clear dst_port 80
6637 acl secure dst_port 8080
6638 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006639 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006640 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006641 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6642
6643 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006644 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6645 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6646 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006647 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006648
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006649 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6650 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6651 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6652
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006653 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006654 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006655
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006656 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006657 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6658 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6659 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006661 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006662
6663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006664redisp (deprecated)
6665redispatch (deprecated)
6666 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006669 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006670
6671 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6672 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6673 be able to access the service anymore.
6674
6675 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6676 redistribute them to a working server.
6677
6678 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6679 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6680 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006682 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6683 "option redispatch" instead.
6684
6685 See also : "option redispatch"
6686
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006687
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006688reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006689 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6691 no | yes | yes | yes
6692 Arguments :
6693 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6694 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006695 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006696
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006697 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6698 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6699
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006700 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6701 the last header of an HTTP request.
6702
6703 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6704 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6705 responses.
6706
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006707 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6708 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6709 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6710
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006711 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6712 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006713
6714
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006715reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6716reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006717 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6719 no | yes | yes | yes
6720 Arguments :
6721 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6722 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6723 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6724 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6725 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6726 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6727 ignores case.
6728
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006729 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6730 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6731
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006732 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6733 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6734 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6735 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006736 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006737
6738 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6739 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6740
6741 Example :
6742 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6743 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6744 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6745
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006746 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6747 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006748
6749
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006750reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6751reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006752 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6754 no | yes | yes | yes
6755 Arguments :
6756 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6757 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6758 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6759 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6760 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6761 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6762
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006763 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6764 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6765
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006766 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6767 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6768 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6769 next servers.
6770
6771 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6772 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6773 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6774
6775 Example :
6776 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6777 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6778 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6779
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006780 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6781 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006782
6783
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006784reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6785reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006786 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6788 no | yes | yes | yes
6789 Arguments :
6790 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6791 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6792 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6793 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6794 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6795 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6796 case.
6797
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006798 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6799 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6800
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006801 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6802 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6803 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6804 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006805 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006806
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006807 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006808 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006809 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006810
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006811 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6812 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6813
6814 Example :
6815 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6816 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6817 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6818
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006819 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6820 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006821
6822
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006823reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6824reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006825 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 no | yes | yes | yes
6828 Arguments :
6829 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6830 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6831 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6832 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6833 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6834 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6835 case.
6836
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006837 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6838 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6839
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006840 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6841 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6842 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6843 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6844
6845 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6846 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6847
6848 Example :
6849 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6850 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6851 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6852 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6853
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006854 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6855 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006856
6857
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006858reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6859reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006860 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 no | yes | yes | yes
6863 Arguments :
6864 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6865 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6866 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6867 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6868 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6869 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6870
6871 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6872 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6873 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6874 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006875 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006876
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006877 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6878 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6879
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006880 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6881 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6882 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6883
6884 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6885 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6886 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6887 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6888 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6889
6890 Example :
6891 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006892 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006893 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6894 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6895
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006896 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
6897 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006898
6899
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006900reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6901reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006902 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6904 no | yes | yes | yes
6905 Arguments :
6906 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6907 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6908 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6909 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6910 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6911 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6912 ignores case.
6913
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006914 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6915 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6916
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006917 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6918 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006919 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6920 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6921 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006922 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6923 not set.
6924
6925 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6926 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6927 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6928 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6929 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6930
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006931 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006932 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6933 # block all others.
6934 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6935 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6936
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006937 # block bad guys
6938 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6939 reqitarpit . if badguys
6940
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006941 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
6942 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006943
6944
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006945retries <value>
6946 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6948 yes | no | yes | yes
6949 Arguments :
6950 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6951 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6952 default value is 3.
6953
6954 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6955 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6956 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6957
6958 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006959 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6960 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006961
6962 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6963 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6964
6965 See also : "option redispatch"
6966
6967
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006968rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006969 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6971 no | yes | yes | yes
6972 Arguments :
6973 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6974 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006975 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006976
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006977 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6978 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6979
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006980 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6981 the last header of an HTTP response.
6982
6983 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6984 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6985 responses.
6986
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006987 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
6988 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006989
6990
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006991rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6992rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006993 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6995 no | yes | yes | yes
6996 Arguments :
6997 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6998 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6999 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7000 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7001 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7002 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7003 ignores case.
7004
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007005 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7006 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7007
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007008 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7009 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007010 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007011 client.
7012
7013 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7014 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7015 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7016
7017 Example :
7018 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007019 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007020
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007021 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7022 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007023
7024
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007025rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7026rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007027 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7029 no | yes | yes | yes
7030 Arguments :
7031 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7032 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7033 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7034 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7035 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7036 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7037 ignores case.
7038
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007039 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7040 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7041
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007042 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7043 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7044 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7045 case-sensitive.
7046
7047 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007048 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7049 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7050 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007051
7052 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7053 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7054
7055 Example :
7056 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7057 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7058
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007059 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7060 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007061
7062
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007063rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7064rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007065 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7067 no | yes | yes | yes
7068 Arguments :
7069 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7070 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7071 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7072 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7073 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7074 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7075 ignores case.
7076
7077 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7078 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7079 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7080 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007081 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007082
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007083 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7084 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7085
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007086 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7087 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7088 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7089
7090 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7091 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7092 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7093 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7094 are not case-sensitive.
7095
7096 Example :
7097 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7098 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7099
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007100 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7101 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007102
7103
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007104server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007105 Declare a server in a backend
7106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7107 no | no | yes | yes
7108 Arguments :
7109 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007110 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007111 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007112
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007113 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7114 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7115 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7116 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007117 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7118 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7119 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7120 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7121 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007122 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7123 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7124 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7125 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7126 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7127 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7128 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007129 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007130 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7131 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7132 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007133
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007134 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007135 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7136 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7137 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7138 adding this value to the client's port.
7139
7140 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7141 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007142 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007143
7144 Examples :
7145 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7146 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007147 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007148 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7149 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7150 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007151
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007152 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7153 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7154 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7155 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7156 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7157
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007158 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7159 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007160
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007161server-state-file-name [<file>]
7162 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7163 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7164 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7165 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7166 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7167 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7168
7169 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7170 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7171
7172 global
7173 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7174
7175 backend bk
7176 load-server-state-from-file
7177
7178 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7179 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007180
7181source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007182source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007183source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007184 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7186 yes | no | yes | yes
7187 Arguments :
7188 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7189 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007190
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007191 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007192 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7193 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7194 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7195 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7196 supported prefixes are :
7197 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7198 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7199 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007200 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007201 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7202 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007203
7204 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7205 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007206 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7207 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7208 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007209
7210 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7211 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7212 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7213 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7214 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7215 <addr>.
7216
7217 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7218 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7219 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7220 port.
7221
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007222 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7223 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7224 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7225 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007226 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007227 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7228 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7229 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7230 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7231 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7232 HTTP header.
7233
7234 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7235 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007236 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007237 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7238 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7239 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7240 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7241 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7242 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7243 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7244
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007245 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7246 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7247 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7248 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7249 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7250 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7251
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007252 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7253 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7254 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7255 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7256
7257 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7258 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7259 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7260 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7261 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7262 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7263
7264 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7265 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7266 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7267 there are two methods :
7268
7269 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7270 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7271 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7272 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7273 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7274 of the client ranges may be used.
7275
7276 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7277 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7278 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7279 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7280 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7281 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7282 same session.
7283
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007284 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7285 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7286 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007287 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007288
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007289 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7290
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007291 Examples :
7292 backend private
7293 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7294 source 192.168.1.200
7295
7296 backend transparent_ssl1
7297 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7298 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7299
7300 backend transparent_ssl2
7301 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7302 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7303 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7304
7305 backend transparent_ssl3
7306 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7307 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7308 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7309
7310 backend transparent_smtp
7311 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7312 # with Tproxy version 4.
7313 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7314
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007315 backend transparent_http
7316 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7317 # proxy.
7318 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007320 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007321 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007323
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007324srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7325 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7327 yes | no | yes | yes
7328 Arguments :
7329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7331 as explained at the top of this document.
7332
7333 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7334 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7335 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7336 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7337 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7338 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7339 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7340
7341 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7342 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7343 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7344 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7345 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007346 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007347 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007348 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007349
7350 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7351 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7352 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7353 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7354 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7355 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7356
7357 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7358 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7359
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007360 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7361 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007362
7363
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007364stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7365 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007367 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007368
7369 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7370 matched.
7371
7372 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7373 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7374
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007375 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7376 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7377 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7378
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007379 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7380 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7381 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7382 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007383
7384 Example :
7385 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7386 backend stats_localhost
7387 stats enable
7388 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7389
7390 Example :
7391 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7392 backend stats_auth
7393 stats enable
7394 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7395 stats admin if TRUE
7396
7397 Example :
7398 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7399 userlist stats-auth
7400 group admin users admin
7401 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7402 group readonly users haproxy
7403 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7404
7405 backend stats_auth
7406 stats enable
7407 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7408 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7409 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7410 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7411
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007412 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7413 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7414 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007415
7416
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007417stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7418 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007420 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007421 Arguments :
7422 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7423
7424 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7425
7426 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7427 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7428 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7429 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7430 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7431 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7432
7433 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7434 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7435 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007436 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007437
7438 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7439 report using "stats scope".
7440
7441 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7442 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7443 unobvious parameters.
7444
7445 Example :
7446 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7447 backend public_www
7448 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7449 stats enable
7450 stats hide-version
7451 stats scope .
7452 stats uri /admin?stats
7453 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7454 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7455 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7456
7457 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7458 backend private_monitoring
7459 stats enable
7460 stats uri /admin?stats
7461 stats refresh 5s
7462
7463 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7464
7465
7466stats enable
7467 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007469 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007470 Arguments : none
7471
7472 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7473 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7474 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7475 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7476 - stats auth : no authentication
7477 - stats scope : no restriction
7478
7479 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7480 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7481 unobvious parameters.
7482
7483 Example :
7484 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7485 backend public_www
7486 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7487 stats enable
7488 stats hide-version
7489 stats scope .
7490 stats uri /admin?stats
7491 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7492 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7493 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7494
7495 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7496 backend private_monitoring
7497 stats enable
7498 stats uri /admin?stats
7499 stats refresh 5s
7500
7501 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7502
7503
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007504stats hide-version
7505 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007507 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007508 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007509
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007510 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7511 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7512 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7513 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7514 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7515 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007517 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7518 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7519 unobvious parameters.
7520
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007521 Example :
7522 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7523 backend public_www
7524 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007525 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007526 stats hide-version
7527 stats scope .
7528 stats uri /admin?stats
7529 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7530 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7531 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007532
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007533 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7534 backend private_monitoring
7535 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007536 stats uri /admin?stats
7537 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007538
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007539 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007540
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007541
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007542stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7543 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7544 Access control for statistics
7545
7546 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7547 no | no | yes | yes
7548
7549 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7550 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7551 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7552 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7553 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7554 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7555
7556 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7557 instance.
7558
7559 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7560 about ACL usage.
7561
7562
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007563stats realm <realm>
7564 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007566 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007567 Arguments :
7568 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7569 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7570 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7571
7572 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7573 using a backslash ('\').
7574
7575 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7576 only related to authentication.
7577
7578 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7579 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7580 unobvious parameters.
7581
7582 Example :
7583 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7584 backend public_www
7585 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7586 stats enable
7587 stats hide-version
7588 stats scope .
7589 stats uri /admin?stats
7590 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7591 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7592 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7593
7594 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7595 backend private_monitoring
7596 stats enable
7597 stats uri /admin?stats
7598 stats refresh 5s
7599
7600 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7601
7602
7603stats refresh <delay>
7604 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007606 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007607 Arguments :
7608 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7609 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7610 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7611 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7612 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7613 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7614
7615 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7616 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7617 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7618 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7619
7620 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7621 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7622 unobvious parameters.
7623
7624 Example :
7625 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7626 backend public_www
7627 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7628 stats enable
7629 stats hide-version
7630 stats scope .
7631 stats uri /admin?stats
7632 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7633 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7634 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7635
7636 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7637 backend private_monitoring
7638 stats enable
7639 stats uri /admin?stats
7640 stats refresh 5s
7641
7642 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7643
7644
7645stats scope { <name> | "." }
7646 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007648 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007649 Arguments :
7650 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7651 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7652 section in which the statement appears.
7653
7654 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7655 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7656 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7657 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7658 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7659 exists.
7660
7661 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7662 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7663 unobvious parameters.
7664
7665 Example :
7666 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7667 backend public_www
7668 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7669 stats enable
7670 stats hide-version
7671 stats scope .
7672 stats uri /admin?stats
7673 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7674 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7675 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7676
7677 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7678 backend private_monitoring
7679 stats enable
7680 stats uri /admin?stats
7681 stats refresh 5s
7682
7683 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7684
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007685
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007686stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007687 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007689 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007690
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007691 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007692 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7693
7694 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7695 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7696
7697 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7698 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007699 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007700
7701 Example :
7702 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7703 backend private_monitoring
7704 stats enable
7705 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7706 stats uri /admin?stats
7707 stats refresh 5s
7708
7709 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7710 global section.
7711
7712
7713stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007714 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 yes | yes | yes | yes
7717 Arguments : none
7718
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007719 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007720 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7721 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7722 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7723 - IP (socket, server)
7724 - cookie (backend, server)
7725
7726 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7727 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007728 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007729
7730 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7731
7732
7733stats show-node [ <name> ]
7734 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007736 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007737 Arguments:
7738 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7739 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7740
7741 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7742 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007743 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007744
7745 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7746 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7747 unobvious parameters.
7748
7749 Example:
7750 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7751 backend private_monitoring
7752 stats enable
7753 stats show-node Europe-1
7754 stats uri /admin?stats
7755 stats refresh 5s
7756
7757 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7758 section.
7759
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007760
7761stats uri <prefix>
7762 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007764 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007765 Arguments :
7766 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7767 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7768 query string.
7769
7770 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7771 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7772 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7773 possible to reach it in the application.
7774
7775 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007776 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007777 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7778 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7779 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7780 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7781
7782 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7783 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7784 an address or a port to statistics only.
7785
7786 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7787 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7788 unobvious parameters.
7789
7790 Example :
7791 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7792 backend public_www
7793 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7794 stats enable
7795 stats hide-version
7796 stats scope .
7797 stats uri /admin?stats
7798 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7799 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7800 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7801
7802 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7803 backend private_monitoring
7804 stats enable
7805 stats uri /admin?stats
7806 stats refresh 5s
7807
7808 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7809
7810
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007811stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7812 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007814 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007815
7816 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007817 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007818 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7819 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7820 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7821
7822 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7823 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7824 the "stick-table" statement.
7825
7826 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7827 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7828 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7829 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7830 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7831
7832 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7833 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7834 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7835 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7836 transformation rules.
7837
7838 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7839 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7840 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7841 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7842 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7843 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7844 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7845
7846 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7847 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7848 ACL based conditions.
7849
7850 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7851 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7852 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7853 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7854
7855 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7856 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7857 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7858 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7859
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007860 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7861 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7862 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7863
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007864 Example :
7865 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7866 # last 30 minutes
7867 backend pop
7868 mode tcp
7869 balance roundrobin
7870 stick store-request src
7871 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7872 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7873 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7874
7875 backend smtp
7876 mode tcp
7877 balance roundrobin
7878 stick match src table pop
7879 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7880 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7881
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007882 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007883 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007884
7885
7886stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7887 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7889 no | no | yes | yes
7890
7891 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7892 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7893 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7894 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7895
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007896 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7897 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7898 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7899
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007900 Examples :
7901 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007902 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007903
7904 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7905 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7906 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7907
7908
7909 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7910 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7911 backend http
7912 mode http
7913 balance roundrobin
7914 stick on src table https
7915 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7916 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7917 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7918
7919 backend https
7920 mode tcp
7921 balance roundrobin
7922 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7923 stick on src
7924 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7925 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7926
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007927 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007928
7929
7930stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7931 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7933 no | no | yes | yes
7934
7935 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007936 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007937 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7938 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7939 server is selected.
7940
7941 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7942 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7943 the "stick-table" statement.
7944
7945 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7946 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7947 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7948 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7949 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7950 address.
7951
7952 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7953 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7954 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7955 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7956 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7957 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7958 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7959 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7960 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7961 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7962
7963 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7964 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7965 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7966 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7967 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7968 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7969 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7970
7971 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7972 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7973 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7974 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7975
7976 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7977 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7978 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7979 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7980 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7981 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007982 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7983 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7984 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7985 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7986 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7987 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007988
7989 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7990 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7991 the request.
7992
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007993 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7994 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7995 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7996
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007997 Example :
7998 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7999 # last 30 minutes
8000 backend pop
8001 mode tcp
8002 balance roundrobin
8003 stick store-request src
8004 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8005 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8006 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8007
8008 backend smtp
8009 mode tcp
8010 balance roundrobin
8011 stick match src table pop
8012 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8013 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8014
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008015 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008016 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008017
8018
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008019stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008020 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8021 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008022 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008024 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008025
8026 Arguments :
8027 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8028 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8029 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8030 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8031
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008032 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8033 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8034 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8035 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8036
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008037 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8038 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8039 instance.
8040
8041 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8042 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8043 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8044 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8045 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8046 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008047 to 32 characters.
8048
8049 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8050 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8051 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008052 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008053 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8054 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008055
8056 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008057 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8058 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008059 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8060 increase.
8061
8062 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008063 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8064 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8065 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008066
8067 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8068 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8069 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8070 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8071 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8072 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8073 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8074 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8075 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8076 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8077 parameter (see below).
8078
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008079 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8080 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8081 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8082 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8083 soft restart.
8084
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008085 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8086 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008087
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008088 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8089 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8090 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8091 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8092 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008093 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008094 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8095 if not expiration delay is specified.
8096
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008097 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8098 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8099 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8100 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008101 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8102 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8103 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8104 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8105 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8106 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8107 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8108 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8109 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8110 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8111 types and their arguments.
8112
8113 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8114 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8115 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8116 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8117
8118 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8119 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8120 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8121 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8122
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008123 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8124 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8125 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8126 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8127 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8128 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8129
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008130 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8131 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8132 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8133 they were received.
8134
8135 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8136 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8137 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8138 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8139 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8140
8141 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8142 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8143 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8144 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8145 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8146
8147 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8148 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8149 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8150
8151 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8152 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8153 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8154 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8155 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8156
8157 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8158 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8159 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8160 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8161 the client side.
8162
8163 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8164 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8165 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8166 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8167 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8168 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8169 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8170
8171 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8172 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8173 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8174 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8175 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8176 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8177 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8178
8179 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8180 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8181 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8182 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8183 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8184 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8185
8186 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8187 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8188 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8189 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8190
8191 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8192 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8193 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8194 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8195 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8196 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8197 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8198 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8199 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8200 recommended for better fairness.
8201
8202 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8203 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8204 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8205 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8206
8207 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8208 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8209 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8210 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8211 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8212 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8213 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8214 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8215 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8216 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008217
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008218 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8219 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008220 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8221 reference it.
8222
8223 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8224 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008225 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8226 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8227 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008228
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008229 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8230 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8231 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8232 something that can be ignored.
8233
8234 Example:
8235 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8236 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8237 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8238 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8239
8240 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008241 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008242
8243
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008244stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008245 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8247 no | no | yes | yes
8248
8249 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008250 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008251 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8252 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8253 server is selected.
8254
8255 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8256 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8257 the "stick-table" statement.
8258
8259 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8260 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8261 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8262 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8263
8264 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8265 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8266 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8267 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8268 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8269 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008270 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008271 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8272 rules.
8273
8274 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8275 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8276 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8277 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8278 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8279 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8280 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8281
8282 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8283 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8284 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8285 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8286
8287 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8288 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8289 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8290 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8291 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8292 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008293 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8294 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8295 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8296 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8297 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8298 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8299 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8300 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8301 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008302
8303 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8304
8305 Example :
8306 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8307 backend https
8308 mode tcp
8309 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008310 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008311 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008312
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008313 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8314 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8315
8316 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8317 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8318 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8319
8320 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8321 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008322
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008323 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8324 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8325 # at offset 44.
8326
8327 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8328 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8329
8330 # Learn on response if server hello.
8331 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008332
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008333 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8334 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8335
8336 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8337 extraction.
8338
8339
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008340tcp-check connect [params*]
8341 Opens a new connection
8342 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 no | no | yes | yes
8344
8345 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8346 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8347 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8348
8349 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8350 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8351 of the sequence.
8352
8353 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8354 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8355 do.
8356
8357 Parameters :
8358 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8359 use the TCP connection.
8360
8361 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8362 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8363 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8364
8365 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8366
8367 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8368
8369 Examples:
8370 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8371 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8372 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8373 option tcp-check
8374 tcp-check connect
8375 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8376 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8377 tcp-check send \r\n
8378 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8379 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8380 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8381 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8382 tcp-check send \r\n
8383 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8384 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8385
8386 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8387 option tcp-check
8388 tcp-check connect port 110
8389 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8390 tcp-check connect port 143
8391 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8392 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8393
8394 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8395
8396
8397tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8398 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8400 no | no | yes | yes
8401
8402 Arguments :
8403 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8404 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8405 binary.
8406 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8407 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8408 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8409
8410 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8411 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8412 with the usual backslash ('\').
8413 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8414 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8415 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8416 used upper or lower case.
8417
8418
8419 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8420
8421 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8422 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8423 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8424 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8425 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8426 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8427 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8428 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8429
8430 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8431 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8432 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8433 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8434 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8435 expression.
8436
8437 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8438 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8439 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8440 this exact hexadecimal string.
8441 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8442
8443 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8444 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8445 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8446 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8447 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8448 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8449 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8450 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8451 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8452 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8453 the null character.
8454
8455 Examples :
8456 # perform a POP check
8457 option tcp-check
8458 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8459
8460 # perform an IMAP check
8461 option tcp-check
8462 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8463
8464 # look for the redis master server
8465 option tcp-check
8466 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008467 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008468 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8469 tcp-check expect string role:master
8470 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8471 tcp-check expect string +OK
8472
8473
8474 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8475 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8476
8477
8478tcp-check send <data>
8479 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8481 no | no | yes | yes
8482
8483 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8484 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8485
8486 Examples :
8487 # look for the redis master server
8488 option tcp-check
8489 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8490 tcp-check expect string role:master
8491
8492 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8493 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8494
8495
8496tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8497 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8498 tcp health check
8499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8500 no | no | yes | yes
8501
8502 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8503 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8504 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8505 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8506 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8507 hexadecimal string.
8508 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8509
8510 Examples :
8511 # redis check in binary
8512 option tcp-check
8513 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8514 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8515
8516
8517 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8518 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8519
8520
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008521tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8522 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8524 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008525 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008526 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8527 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008528
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008529 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008530
8531 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8532 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008533 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8534 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8535 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8536 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8537 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8538 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008540 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8541 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8542 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8543 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008544
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008545 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008546 - accept :
8547 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8548 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8549 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008550
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008551 - reject :
8552 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8553 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8554 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8555 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8556 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8557 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8558 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8559 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8560 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8561 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8562 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8563 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008564
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008565 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8566 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8567 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8568 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8569 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8570 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8571 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8572 hosts.
8573
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008574 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8575 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8576 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8577 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8578 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8579 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8580 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8581 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8582 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008583 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8584 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008585
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008586 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008587 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008588 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008589 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008590 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8591 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008592 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008593 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8594 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8595 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8596 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8597 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008599 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008600 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008601 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008602 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8603 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8604 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8605 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008607 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8608 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8609 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8610 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008611
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008612 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8613 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8614 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8615 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8616 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008617 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8618 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8619 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8620 layer7 information is extracted.
8621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008622 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8623 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8624 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8625 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8626 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008627
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008628 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8629 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8630 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8631 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8632
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008633 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8634 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8635 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8636 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8637 continues.
8638
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008639 - "silent-drop" :
8640 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8641 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8642 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8643 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8644 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8645 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8646 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8647 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8648 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8649 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8650 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8651 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8652 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8653 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8654 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8655 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8656
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008657 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8658 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8659 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008660
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008661 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8662 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8663 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008665 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008666 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008667 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008668
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008669 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8670 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8671 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008672
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008673 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008674 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8675 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008676
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008677 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8678
8679 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8680
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008681 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8682
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008683 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008684
8685
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008686tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8687 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008689 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008690 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008691 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8692 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008693
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008694 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008695
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008696 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8697 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8698 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8699 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8700 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008701
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008702 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8703 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8704 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8705 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008706 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8707 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8708 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8709 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8710 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8711 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008712 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008713 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008714
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008715 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8716 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8717 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8718 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008719
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008720 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008721 - accept : the request is accepted
8722 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8723 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008724 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008725 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008726 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008727 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008728 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008729
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008730 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8731 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008732
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008733 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8734 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8735 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8736 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8737 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8738 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008740 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008741 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8742 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008743
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008744 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008745 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8746 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8747 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8748 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008749 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8750 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8751 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008752
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008753 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008754 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8755 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8756 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008757
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008758 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8759 declared inline.
8760
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008761 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8762 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8763 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8764 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008765 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008766 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008767 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008768 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8769 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008770 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008771 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8772 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008773
8774 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8775 followed by some converters.
8776
8777 Example:
8778
8779 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8780
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008781 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008782 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8783 # and reject everything else.
8784 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8785 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008786 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008787 tcp-request content reject
8788
8789 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008790 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8791 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8792 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008793 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008794
8795 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8796 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8797 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008798 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008799 tcp-request content reject
8800
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008801 Example:
8802 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8803 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008804 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008805
8806 Example:
8807 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8808 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008809 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008811 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8812 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8813
8814 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008815 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008816 # protecting all our sites
8817 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008818 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8819 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008820 ...
8821 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8822
8823 backend http_dynamic
8824 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008825 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008826 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008827 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8828 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8829 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008830 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008832 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008833
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008834 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008835
8836
8837tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8838 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008840 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008841 Arguments :
8842 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8843 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8844 as explained at the top of this document.
8845
8846 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8847 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8848 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8849 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8850 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8851
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008852 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8853 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8854 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8855 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8856
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008857 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8858 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008859 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008860 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008861 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8862 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8863 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8864 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008865
8866 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8867 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8868 it pass through unaffected.
8869
8870 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8871 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8872 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008873 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008874 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8875 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008876 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8877 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8878 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008879
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008880 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008881 "timeout client".
8882
8883
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008884tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8885 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8887 no | no | yes | yes
8888 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008889 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8890 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008891
8892 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8893
8894 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8895 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8896 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008897 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8898 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008899
8900 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8901
8902 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8903 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8904 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8905 inserted.
8906
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008907 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008908 - accept :
8909 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8910 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8911 the rules evaluation.
8912
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008913 - close :
8914 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8915 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8916 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8917 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8918 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8919 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008920 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008921 protocols.
8922
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008923 - reject :
8924 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8925 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008926 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008927
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008928 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8929 Sets a variable.
8930
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008931 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8932 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8933 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
8934 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
8935
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008936 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
8937 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8938 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8939 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8940 continues.
8941
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008942 - "silent-drop" :
8943 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8944 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8945 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8946 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8947 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8948 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8949 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8950 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8951 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8952 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8953 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8954 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8955 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8956 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8957 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8958 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8959
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008960 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8961 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8962 for changing the default action to a reject.
8963
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008964 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8965 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8966 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8967 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008968 period.
8969
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008970 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8971 declared inline.
8972
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008973 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8974 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8975 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8976 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008977 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008978 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008979 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008980 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8981 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008982 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008983 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8984 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008985
8986 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8987 followed by some converters.
8988
8989 Example:
8990
8991 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8992
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008993 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8994
8995 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8996
8997
8998tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8999 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9001 no | no | yes | yes
9002 Arguments :
9003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9005 as explained at the top of this document.
9006
9007 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9008
9009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009010timeout check <timeout>
9011 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9012 established.
9013
9014 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9015 yes | no | yes | yes
9016 Arguments:
9017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9019 as explained at the top of this document.
9020
9021 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9022 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9023 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9024 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009025 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9026 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9027 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009028
9029 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9030 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9031
9032 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9033 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009034 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009035
9036 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9037 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9038 forget about it.
9039
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009040 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9041 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009042
9043
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009044timeout client <timeout>
9045timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9046 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9048 yes | yes | yes | no
9049 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009050 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009051 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9052 as explained at the top of this document.
9053
9054 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9055 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9056 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009057 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9058 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9059 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9060 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009061 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9062 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9063 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009064 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009065 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009066 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9067 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009068 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9069 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009070
9071 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9072 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9073 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9074 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9075 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9076 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9077
9078 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9079 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9080 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9081
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009082 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9083 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009084
9085
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009086timeout client-fin <timeout>
9087 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9089 yes | yes | yes | no
9090 Arguments :
9091 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9092 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9093 as explained at the top of this document.
9094
9095 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9096 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9097 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9098 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9099 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9100 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9101 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9102 down in one direction.
9103
9104 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9105 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9106 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9107
9108 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9109
9110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009111timeout connect <timeout>
9112timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9113 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9115 yes | no | yes | yes
9116 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009117 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009118 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9119 as explained at the top of this document.
9120
9121 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009122 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009123 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009124 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009125 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9126 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009127
9128 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9129 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9130 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9131 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9132 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9133 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9134
9135 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9136 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9137 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9138
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009139 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9140 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009141
9142
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009143timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9144 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9146 yes | yes | yes | yes
9147 Arguments :
9148 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9150 as explained at the top of this document.
9151
9152 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9153 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9154 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9155 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9156 once the request has started to present itself.
9157
9158 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9159 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9160 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9161 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9162 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9163
9164 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9165 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9166 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9167 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9168
9169 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9170 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9171 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9172 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9173 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009174 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009175
9176 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9177 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9178 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9179 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9180
9181 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9182
9183
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009184timeout http-request <timeout>
9185 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009187 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009188 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009189 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009190 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9191 as explained at the top of this document.
9192
9193 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9194 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9195 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9196 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9197 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9198 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9199 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009200 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9201 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9202 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9203 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9204 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009205 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9206 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009207
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009208 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9209 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9210 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9211 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9212 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009213 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009214
9215 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9216 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9217 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9218 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9219 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9220
9221 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009222 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9223 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9224 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009225
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009226 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009227 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009228
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009229
9230timeout queue <timeout>
9231 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9233 yes | no | yes | yes
9234 Arguments :
9235 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9236 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9237 as explained at the top of this document.
9238
9239 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9240 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9241 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9242 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9243 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9244
9245 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9246 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9247 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9248 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9249
9250 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9251
9252
9253timeout server <timeout>
9254timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9255 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9257 yes | no | yes | yes
9258 Arguments :
9259 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9260 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9261 as explained at the top of this document.
9262
9263 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9264 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9265 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9266 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9267 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9268 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9269 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9270
9271 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9272 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9273 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9274 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9275 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009276 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009277 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009278 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9279 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9280 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9281 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009282
9283 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9284 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9285 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9286 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9287 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9288 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9289
9290 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9291 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9292 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9293
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009294 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009295
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009296
9297timeout server-fin <timeout>
9298 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9300 yes | no | yes | yes
9301 Arguments :
9302 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9303 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9304 as explained at the top of this document.
9305
9306 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9307 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9308 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9309 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9310 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9311 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9312 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9313 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9314 situations, it should not be needed.
9315
9316 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9317 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9318 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9319
9320 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9321
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009322
9323timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009324 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9326 yes | yes | yes | yes
9327 Arguments :
9328 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9329 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9330 as explained at the top of this document.
9331
9332 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9333 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9334 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9335
9336 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9337 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9338 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9339 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009340 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009341
9342 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9343
9344
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009345timeout tunnel <timeout>
9346 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9348 yes | no | yes | yes
9349 Arguments :
9350 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9351 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9352 as explained at the top of this document.
9353
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009354 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009355 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9356 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9357 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9358 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9359 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9360 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9361 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9362 specified.
9363
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009364 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9365 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9366 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9367 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9368 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9369 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9370 state.
9371
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009372 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9373 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9374 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9375 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9376 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9377
9378 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9379 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9380 forget about it.
9381
9382 Example :
9383 defaults http
9384 option http-server-close
9385 timeout connect 5s
9386 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009387 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009388 timeout server 30s
9389 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9390
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009391 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009392
9393
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009394transparent (deprecated)
9395 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009397 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009398 Arguments : none
9399
9400 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9401 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9402 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9403 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9404 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9405 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9406 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9407 appropriate server.
9408
9409 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9410
9411 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9412 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9413
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009414 See also: "option transparent"
9415
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009416unique-id-format <string>
9417 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9419 yes | yes | yes | no
9420 Arguments :
9421 <string> is a log-format string.
9422
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009423 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9424 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9425 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9426 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009427
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009428 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9429 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9430 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9431 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9432 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9433 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9434 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9435 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009436
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009437 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9438 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009439
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009440 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009441
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009442 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009443
9444 will generate:
9445
9446 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9447
9448 See also: "unique-id-header"
9449
9450unique-id-header <name>
9451 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9453 yes | yes | yes | no
9454 Arguments :
9455 <name> is the name of the header.
9456
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009457 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9458 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009459
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009460 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009461
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009462 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009463 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9464
9465 will generate:
9466
9467 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9468
9469 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009470
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009471use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009472 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9474 no | yes | yes | no
9475 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009476 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9477 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009478
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009479 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9480 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009481
9482 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9483 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9484 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009485 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9486 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9487 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9488 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009489
9490 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9491 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9492 assign the backend.
9493
9494 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9495 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9496 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9497 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9498 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9499 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9500
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009501 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009502 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009503 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9504 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9505 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9506
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009507 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9508 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9509 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9510 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9511 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9512 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9513 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9514 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9515 cannot be forced from the request.
9516
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009517 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009518 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9519 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9520
9521 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9522 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009523
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009524
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009525use-server <server> if <condition>
9526use-server <server> unless <condition>
9527 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9529 no | no | yes | yes
9530 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009531 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009532
9533 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9534
9535 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9536 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9537 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9538
9539 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9540 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9541 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9542 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9543 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9544 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9545 matches will assign the server.
9546
9547 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9548 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9549 with the next rules until one matches.
9550
9551 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9552 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9553 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9554 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9555
9556 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9557 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9558 stripped.
9559
9560 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9561 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9562 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9563 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9564
9565 Example :
9566 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9567 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9568 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9569 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9570 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9571 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9572 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9573 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9574 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9575
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009576 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009577
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009578
95795. Bind and Server options
9580--------------------------
9581
9582The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9583depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9584settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9585written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9586described in this section.
9587
9588
95895.1. Bind options
9590-----------------
9591
9592The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9593as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9594no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9595parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9596while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9597provided immediately after the setting name.
9598
9599The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9600
9601accept-proxy
9602 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009603 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9604 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009605 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9606 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9607 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9608 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9609 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9610 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9611 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009612 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9613 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009614
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009615alpn <protocols>
9616 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9617 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9618 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9619 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9620 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9621 initial NPN extension.
9622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009623backlog <backlog>
9624 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9625 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9626
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009627ecdhe <named curve>
9628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009629 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9630 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009631
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009632ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9634 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9635 client's certificate.
9636
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009637ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9639 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9640 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9641 error is ignored.
9642
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009643ca-sign-file <cafile>
9644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9645 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9646 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9647 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9648 'generate-certificates' for details.
9649
9650ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9652 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9653 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9654 'generate-certificates' for details.
9655
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009656ciphers <ciphers>
9657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9658 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009659 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009660 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9661 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9662
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009663crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9665 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9666 to verify client's certificate.
9667
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009668crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9670 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9671 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9672 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9673 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9674 file.
9675
9676 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9677 are loaded.
9678
9679 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009680 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009681 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9682 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9683 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9684 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9685 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9686 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9687 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009688
9689 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9690 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9691 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9692 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009693 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9694 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009695
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009696 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009697
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009698 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9699 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009700 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009701 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9702 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9703 clients).
9704
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009705 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9706 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9707 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9708 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9709 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9710 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9711 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9712 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9713 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9714 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9715 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9716 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9717 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9718
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009719 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9720 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9721 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9722 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9723 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9724
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009725 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9726 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9727 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9728 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009729
9730 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9731 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9732 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9733 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9734 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9735 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9736 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9737 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9738 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9739
9740 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9741
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009742 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009743 a cert bundle.
9744
9745 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9746 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9747 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9748 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9749 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9750 provide multi-cert support.
9751
9752 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9753
9754 Filename | CN | SAN
9755 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9756 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009757 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009758 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9759 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9760
9761 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9762 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9763 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9764 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9765 suites.
9766
9767 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9768 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9769
9770 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9771 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9772 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9773
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009774crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9776 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009777 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009778 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009779
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009780crt-list <file>
9781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009782 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9783 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009784
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009785 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009786
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009787 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9788 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9789 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9790 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9791 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9792 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9793 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9794 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009795
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009796 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
9797 the base name is given in the crt-list. Due to the nature of bundling, all SNI
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009798 filters given to a multi-cert bundle entry are ignored.
9799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009800defer-accept
9801 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9802 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9803 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9804 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9805 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9806 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9807 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9808 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9809 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9810 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9811 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9812
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009813force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009814 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009815 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009816 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9817 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009818
9819force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009820 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009821 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9822 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009823
9824force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009825 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009826 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9827 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009828
9829force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009830 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009831 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9832 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009833
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009834generate-certificates
9835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9836 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9837 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9838 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9839 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9840 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9841 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9842 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9843 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9844 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9845 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9846
9847 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9848 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9849 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9850 certificate is used many times.
9851
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009852gid <gid>
9853 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9854 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9855 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9856 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9857 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9858
9859group <group>
9860 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9861 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9862 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9863 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9864 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9865
9866id <id>
9867 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9868 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9869 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9870 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9871
9872interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009873 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9874 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9875 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9876 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9877 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9878 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9879 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009880
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009881level <level>
9882 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9883 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9884 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9885 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9886 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9887 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9888 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9889 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9890 counters).
9891 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9892 all counters).
9893
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009894maxconn <maxconn>
9895 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9896 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9897 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9898 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9899 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9900 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9901 eat all memory.
9902
9903mode <mode>
9904 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9905 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9906 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9907 UNIX sockets.
9908
9909mss <maxseg>
9910 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9911 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9912 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9913 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9914 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9915 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9916 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9917 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9918 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9919 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9920 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9921
9922name <name>
9923 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9924 page.
9925
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +02009926namespace <name>
9927 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
9928 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
9929 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
9930 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
9931
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009932nice <nice>
9933 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9934 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9935 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9936 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9937 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9938 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9939 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9940 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9941 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9942 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9943 one for an RDP socket.
9944
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009945no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009947 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009948 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009949 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9950 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009951 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009952
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009953no-tls-tickets
9954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9955 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9956 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009957 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9958 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009959
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009960no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009961 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009962 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009963 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009964 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9965 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9966 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009967
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009968no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009969 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009970 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009971 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009972 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9973 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9974 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009975
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009976no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009978 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009979 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009980 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9981 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9982 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009983
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009984npn <protocols>
9985 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9986 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9987 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9988 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009989 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9990 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009991
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009992process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9993 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9994 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9995 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9996 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9997 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9998 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9999 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010000 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10001 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10002 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10003 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10004 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10005 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10006 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010008ssl
10009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010010 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010011 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10012 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10013 to deciphered contents.
10014
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010015strict-sni
10016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10017 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10018 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10019 See the "crt" option for more information.
10020
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010021tcp-ut <delay>
10022 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10023 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10024 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10025 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10026 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10027 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10028 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10029 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10030 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10031 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10032 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10033
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010034tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010035 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010036 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10037 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10038 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10039 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10040 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10041 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10042 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010043 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10044 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10045 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010046
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010047tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10048 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10049 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10050 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10051 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10052 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10053 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10054 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10055 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10056 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10057 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10058
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010059transparent
10060 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10061 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10062 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10063 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10064 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10065 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10066 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10067 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10068 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10069 so check for support with your vendor.
10070
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010071v4v6
10072 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10073 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10074 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10075 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010076 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010077
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010078v6only
10079 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10080 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10081 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010082 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10083 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010084
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010085uid <uid>
10086 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10087 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10088 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10089 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10090 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10091
10092user <user>
10093 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10094 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10095 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10096 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10097 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10098
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010099verify [none|optional|required]
10100 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10101 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10102 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10103 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10104 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010105 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10106 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10107 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10108 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200101105.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010111------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010113The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10114which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10115arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10116settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10117after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10118Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10119address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010121 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010122 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010124The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010125
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010126addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010127 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010128 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10129 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10130 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10131 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10132 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010133
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010134 Supported in default-server: No
10135
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010136agent-check
10137 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010138 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10139 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10140 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10141 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010142
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010143 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010144 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010145 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10146 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10147 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010148
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010149 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10150 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010151
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010152 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10153 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10154 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010155
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010156 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10157 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10158 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010159
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010160 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10161 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10162 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10163 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10164 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10165 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10166 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010167
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010168 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10169 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010170
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010171 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10172 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10173 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10174 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10175 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10176 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10177 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10178 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10179 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010180
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010181 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10182 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010183 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10184 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10185 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010186 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010187
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010188 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10189 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010190
10191 Supported in default-server: No
10192
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010193agent-send <string>
10194 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10195 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10196 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10197 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10198 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10199
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010200agent-inter <delay>
10201 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10202 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10203
10204 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10205 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10206 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10207 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10208 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10209 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10210 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10211 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10212 of backends use the same servers.
10213
10214 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10215
10216 Supported in default-server: Yes
10217
10218agent-port <port>
10219 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10220
10221 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10222
10223 Supported in default-server: Yes
10224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010225backup
10226 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10227 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10228 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10229 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10230 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10231 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010233 Supported in default-server: No
10234
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010235ca-file <cafile>
10236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10237 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10238 server's certificate.
10239
10240 Supported in default-server: No
10241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010242check
10243 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010244 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10245 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10246 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10247 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10248 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10249 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10250 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010251 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10252 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10253 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010255 Supported in default-server: No
10256
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010257check-send-proxy
10258 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10259 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10260 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10261 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10262 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10263 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10264 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10265
10266 Supported in default-server: No
10267
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010268check-ssl
10269 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10270 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10271 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10272 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010273 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010274 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10275 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10276 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10277 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10278
10279 Supported in default-server: No
10280
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010281ciphers <ciphers>
10282 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010283 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010284 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10285 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10286 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10287 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10288 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10289 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10290
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010291 Supported in default-server: No
10292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010293cookie <value>
10294 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10295 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10296 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10297 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10298 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10299 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10300 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010302 Supported in default-server: No
10303
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010304crl-file <crlfile>
10305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10306 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10307 to verify server's certificate.
10308
10309 Supported in default-server: No
10310
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010311crt <cert>
10312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10313 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10314 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10315 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10316 certificate request.
10317
10318 Supported in default-server: No
10319
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010320disabled
10321 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10322 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10323 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10324 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10325 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10326
10327 Supported in default-server: No
10328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010329error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010330 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10331 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10332 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010334 Supported in default-server: Yes
10335
10336 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010338fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010339 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10340 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10341 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010343 Supported in default-server: Yes
10344
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010345force-sslv3
10346 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10347 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010348 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10349 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010350
10351 Supported in default-server: No
10352
10353force-tlsv10
10354 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010355 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10356 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010357
10358 Supported in default-server: No
10359
10360force-tlsv11
10361 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010362 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10363 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010364
10365 Supported in default-server: No
10366
10367force-tlsv12
10368 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010369 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10370 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010371
10372 Supported in default-server: No
10373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010374id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010375 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10376 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10377 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010378
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010379 Supported in default-server: No
10380
10381inter <delay>
10382fastinter <delay>
10383downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010384 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10385 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10386 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10387 between checks depending on the server state :
10388
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010389 Server state | Interval used
10390 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10391 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10392 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10393 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10394 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10395 or yet unchecked. |
10396 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10397 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10398 | "inter" otherwise.
10399 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010401 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10402 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10403 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10404 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010405 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10406 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10407 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10408 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10409 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010411 Supported in default-server: Yes
10412
10413maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010414 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10415 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10416 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10417 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10418 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10419 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10420 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10421 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010423 Supported in default-server: Yes
10424
10425maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010426 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10427 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10428 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10429 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10430 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10431 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10432 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010434 Supported in default-server: Yes
10435
10436minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010437 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10438 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10439 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10440 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10441 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10442 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010443 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010444 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010446 Supported in default-server: Yes
10447
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010448namespace <name>
10449 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10450 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10451 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10452 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10453
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010454no-ssl-reuse
10455 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10456 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10457 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10458 and for paranoid users.
10459
10460 Supported in default-server: No
10461
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010462no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010463 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10464 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010465 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010466
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010467 Supported in default-server: No
10468
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010469no-tls-tickets
10470 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10471 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10472 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010473 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10474 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010475
10476 Supported in default-server: No
10477
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010478no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010479 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010480 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10481 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010482 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10483 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10484 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010485
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010486 Supported in default-server: No
10487
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010488no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010489 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010490 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10491 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010492 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10493 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10494 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010495
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010496 Supported in default-server: No
10497
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010498no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010499 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010500 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10501 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010502 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10503 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10504 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010505
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010506 Supported in default-server: No
10507
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010508non-stick
10509 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10510 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10511 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10512
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010513 Supported in default-server: No
10514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010515observe <mode>
10516 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10517 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10518 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10519 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10520 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10521 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010522 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010524 Supported in default-server: No
10525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010526 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010528on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010529 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10530 Currently, four modes are available:
10531 - fastinter: force fastinter
10532 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10533 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10534 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10535 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010537 Supported in default-server: Yes
10538
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010539 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10540
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010541on-marked-down <action>
10542 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10543 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010544 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10545 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10546 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10547 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10548 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10549 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10550 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10551 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010552
10553 Actions are disabled by default
10554
10555 Supported in default-server: Yes
10556
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010557on-marked-up <action>
10558 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10559 Currently one action is available:
10560 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10561 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10562 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10563 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10564 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10565 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10566 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10567 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10568
10569 Actions are disabled by default
10570
10571 Supported in default-server: Yes
10572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010573port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010574 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10575 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10576 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10577 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10578 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10579 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010581 Supported in default-server: Yes
10582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010583redir <prefix>
10584 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10585 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10586 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10587 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10588 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10589 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10590 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10591 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010592 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010593 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10594 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10595 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10596 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10597 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10598
10599 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010601 Supported in default-server: No
10602
10603rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010604 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10605 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10606 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010608 Supported in default-server: Yes
10609
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010610resolve-prefer <family>
10611 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10612 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10613 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10614 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10615
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010616 Default value: ipv6
10617
10618 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010619
10620 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10621
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010622resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10623 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10624 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10625 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10626 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10627 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10628 configured network, another address is selected.
10629
10630 Supported in default-server: Yes
10631
10632 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
10633
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010634resolvers <id>
10635 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10636 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010637 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10638 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10639 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10640 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010641
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010642 Supported in default-server: No
10643
10644 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010645
10646 See also chapter 5.3
10647
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010648send-proxy
10649 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10650 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10651 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10652 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10653 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10654 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10655 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10656 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10657 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010658 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10659 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10660 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10661 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10662 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010663
10664 Supported in default-server: No
10665
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010666send-proxy-v2
10667 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10668 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10669 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10670 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10671 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10672 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10673 option of the "bind" keyword.
10674
10675 Supported in default-server: No
10676
10677send-proxy-v2-ssl
10678 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10679 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10680 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10681 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10682 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10683 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10684 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10685 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10686
10687 Supported in default-server: No
10688
10689send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10690 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10691 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10692 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10693 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10694 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10695 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10696 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10697 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10698 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10699
10700 Supported in default-server: No
10701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010702slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010703 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10704 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10705 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10706 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10707 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10708 parameters :
10709
10710 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10711 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10712
10713 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10714 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10715 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10716 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10717
10718 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10719 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10720 seen as failed.
10721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010722 Supported in default-server: Yes
10723
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010724sni <expression>
10725 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10726 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10727 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10728 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10729 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10730
10731 Supported in default-server: no
10732
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010733source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010734source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010735source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010736 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10737 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10738 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10739 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10740
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010741 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10742 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10743 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10744 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10745 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10746 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10747 server.
10748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010749 Supported in default-server: No
10750
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010751ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010752 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10753 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10754 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10755 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10756 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10757 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010758 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010759
10760 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010761
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010762tcp-ut <delay>
10763 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10764 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10765 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10766 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10767 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10768 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10769 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10770 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10771 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10772 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10773 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10774 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10775 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010777track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010778 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10779 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10780 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10781 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010782 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010784 Supported in default-server: No
10785
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010786verify [none|required]
10787 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010788 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10789 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10790 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10791 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010792 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10793 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10794 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010795
10796 Supported in default-server: No
10797
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010798verifyhost <hostname>
10799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10800 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10801 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10802 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10803 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10804 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10805
10806 Supported in default-server: No
10807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010808weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010809 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10810 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10811 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010812 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10813 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10814 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10815 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10816 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10817 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010819 Supported in default-server: Yes
10820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010821
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200108225.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10823-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010824
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010825HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10826using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10827configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010828This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10829can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10830workload.
10831This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10832resolution at run time.
10833Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10834carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10835
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010836Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
10837health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
10838
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010839
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200108405.3.1. Global overview
10841----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010842
10843As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10844different steps of the process life:
10845
10846 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10847 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10848 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10849
10850 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10851 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10852 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10853
10854A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10855 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10856 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10857 resolution to know this new IP.
10858
10859A few things important to notice:
10860 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10861 first valid response.
10862
10863 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10864 servers return an error.
10865
10866
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200108675.3.2. The resolvers section
10868----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010869
10870This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10871HAProxy.
10872There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10873many name servers.
10874
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010875When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
10876uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
10877is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
10878answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
10879
10880When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
10881used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
10882
10883Two types of behavior can be applied:
10884 1. stop DNS resolution
10885 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
10886 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
10887 1. ANY query type
10888 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
10889 server's parameter
10890 3. remaining family type
10891
10892HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
10893 - invalid DNS response packet
10894 - wrong name in the query section of the response
10895 - NX domain
10896 - Query refused by server
10897 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
10898
10899HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
10900 - no Answer records in the response
10901 - DNS response truncated
10902 - Error in DNS response
10903 - No expected DNS records found in the response
10904 - name server timeout
10905
10906For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
10907 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
10908 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
10909 applied;
10910 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
10911 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
10912 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
10913 stops resolution.
10914
10915
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010916resolvers <resolvers id>
10917 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10918
10919A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10920
10921nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10922 DNS server description:
10923 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10924 <ip> : IP address of the server
10925 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10926
10927hold <status> <period>
10928 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10929 on last resolution <status>
10930 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10931 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10932 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10933 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10934
10935 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10936
10937 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10938 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10939 the healch check.
10940
10941resolve_retries <nb>
10942 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10943 giving up.
10944 Default value: 3
10945
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010946 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
10947 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
10948 type.
10949
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010950timeout <event> <time>
10951 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10952 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10953 events available are:
10954 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10955 been received.
10956 Default value: 1s
10957 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10958 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10959
10960Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10961
10962 resolvers mydns
10963 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10964 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10965 resolve_retries 3
10966 timeout retry 1s
10967 hold valid 10s
10968
10969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109706. HTTP header manipulation
10971---------------------------
10972
10973In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10974response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10975request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10976which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010977against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010978
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010979If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10980to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10981but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10982HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10983stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10984because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10985a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10986still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010988This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10989in section 4.2 :
10990
10991 - reqadd <string>
10992 - reqallow <search>
10993 - reqiallow <search>
10994 - reqdel <search>
10995 - reqidel <search>
10996 - reqdeny <search>
10997 - reqideny <search>
10998 - reqpass <search>
10999 - reqipass <search>
11000 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11001 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11002 - reqtarpit <search>
11003 - reqitarpit <search>
11004 - rspadd <string>
11005 - rspdel <search>
11006 - rspidel <search>
11007 - rspdeny <search>
11008 - rspideny <search>
11009 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11010 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11011
11012With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11013is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11014parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11015prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11016Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11017
11018 \t for a tab
11019 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11020 \n for a new line (LF)
11021 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11022 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11023 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11024 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11025 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11026
11027The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11028portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11029above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11030regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
110319 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11032is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11033
11034The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11035after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11036
11037Notes related to these keywords :
11038---------------------------------
11039 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11040 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11041 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11042
11043 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11044 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11045 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11046
11047 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11048 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11049 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11050 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11051 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11052
11053 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11054 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11055 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11056 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11057 useless headers before adding new ones.
11058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011059 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011060 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11061
11062 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11063 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11064 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11065
11066 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11067 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011068 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011069
11070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200110717. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11072----------------------------------
11073
11074Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11075client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11076The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11077these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11078but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11079data called patterns.
11080
11081
110827.1. ACL basics
11083---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011084
11085The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11086content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11087from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11088simple :
11089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011090 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011091 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011092 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11093 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011095The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11096adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011097
11098In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011100 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011101
11102This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11103Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11104and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011105an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11106conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11107as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11108are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011109
11110ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11111'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11112which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11113
11114There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11115performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011117The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11118specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11119this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011120methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11121ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122
11123Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11124 - boolean
11125 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11126 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11127 - string
11128 - data block
11129
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011130Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11131converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11132would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11133The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11134which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11135
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011136Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11137keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11138fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11139which are summarized in the table below :
11140
11141 +---------------------+-----------------+
11142 | Sample or converter | Default |
11143 | output type | matching method |
11144 +---------------------+-----------------+
11145 | boolean | bool |
11146 +---------------------+-----------------+
11147 | integer | int |
11148 +---------------------+-----------------+
11149 | ip | ip |
11150 +---------------------+-----------------+
11151 | string | str |
11152 +---------------------+-----------------+
11153 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11154 +---------------------+-----------------+
11155
11156Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11157matching method, see below.
11158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011159The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11160 - boolean
11161 - integer or integer range
11162 - IP address / network
11163 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11164 - regular expression
11165 - hex block
11166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011167The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11168
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011169 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11170 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011171 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011172 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011173 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011174 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011175 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011177The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11178read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11179if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11180lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11181will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11182beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11183a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11184lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11185exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11186
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011187The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11188parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11189ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11190a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11191check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11192
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011193The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11194socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11195file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011197Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11198loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11199
11200 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11201
11202In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11203the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11204case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11205as well.
11206
11207The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11208sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11209do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11210methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11211is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11212obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11213followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11214default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11215that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11216string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11217
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011218The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11219By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11220string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11221resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11222server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11223waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11224flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11225function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011227There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11228sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11229be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011230
11231 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11232 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011233 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11234 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11235 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11236 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011237
11238 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11239 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011240 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011241
11242 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011243 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011244
11245 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011246 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011247
11248 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11249 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11250
11251 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11252 binary or string samples.
11253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011254 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11255 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011257 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11258 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11259 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011261 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11262 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011264 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11265 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011267 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11268 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011270 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11271 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011272 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011274 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11275 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11276 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011277
11278For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11279request, it is possible to do :
11280
11281 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11282
11283In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11284buffer, one would use the following acl :
11285
11286 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11287
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011288On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11289possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11290
11291 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011293All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11294criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11295method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11296to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11297criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11298the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011300If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011301the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11302For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011304 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11305 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11306 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11307 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011308
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011309
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011310The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11311types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11312combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11313brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11314default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011316 +-------------------------------------------------+
11317 | Input sample type |
11318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011319 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11321 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011323 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011324 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011325 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011326 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011327 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011329 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011330 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011331 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011332 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011333 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011334 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011335 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011336 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011337 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011338 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011339 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011340 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011341 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011343 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011344 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11345 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11346 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011347
11348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113497.1.1. Matching booleans
11350------------------------
11351
11352In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11353Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11354When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11355that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11356
11357Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11358return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11359"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11360
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113627.1.2. Matching integers
11363------------------------
11364
11365Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11366enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11367to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11368
11369Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11370matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11371lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011372
11373For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11374unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11375representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11376
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011377As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11378two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11379instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11380ranges and operators.
11381
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011382For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011383operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11384Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11385of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011387Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011388
11389 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11390 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11391 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11392 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11393 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11394
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011395For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011396
11397 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11398
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011399This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11400
11401 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11402
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114047.1.3. Matching strings
11405-----------------------
11406
11407String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11408different forms :
11409
11410 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11411 patterns ;
11412
11413 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11414 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11415
11416 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11417 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11418
11419 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11420 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11421
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011422 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011423 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11424 matches.
11425
11426 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11427 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11428 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011429
11430String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11431exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11432characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11433string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11434to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011435before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011436
11437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114387.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11439---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011440
11441Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11442they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11443possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11444passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11445the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011446the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11447match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011448
11449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114507.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11451-------------------------------------
11452
11453It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11454not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11455a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11456to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11457digits may be used upper or lower case.
11458
11459Example :
11460 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11461 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11462
11463
114647.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11465---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011466
11467IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11468netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11469within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011470host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011471difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11472at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11473does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11474parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011475
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011476IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11477Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11478trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11479IPv6 patterns.
11480
11481HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11482following situations :
11483 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11484 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11485 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11486 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11487 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11488 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11489 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11490 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11491 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11492 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011494
114957.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11496----------------------------------
11497
11498Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11499combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11500
11501 - AND (implicit)
11502 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11503 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011505A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011509Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11510indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011512For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11513"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11514requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11515is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11516
11517 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11518 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11519 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11520 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11521
11522To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11523and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11524
11525 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11526 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11527 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11528 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11529
11530 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11531 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11532 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11533 use_backend www if host_www
11534
11535It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11536expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11537be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11538the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11539
11540 The following rule :
11541
11542 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11543 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11544
11545 Can also be written that way :
11546
11547 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11548
11549It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11550to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11551simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11552sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11553good use is the following :
11554
11555 With named ACLs :
11556
11557 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11558 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11559 monitor fail if site_dead
11560
11561 With anonymous ACLs :
11562
11563 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11564
11565See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11566
11567
115687.3. Fetching samples
11569---------------------
11570
11571Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11572against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11573sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11574ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11575of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11576available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11577
11578This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11579Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11580compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11581deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11582
11583The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11584matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11585method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11586indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11587
11588As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11589when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11590mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11591the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11592ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11593
11594Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11595multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11596when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11597incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11598are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11599is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11600all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11601
11602Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11603 - name
11604 - name(arg1)
11605 - name(arg1,arg2)
11606
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011607
116087.3.1. Converters
11609-----------------
11610
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011611Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11612of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11613is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11614was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11615has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11616unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11617
11618These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11619sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11620the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11621support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011622
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011623A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11624support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11625supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11626(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11627bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011629The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011630
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011631add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011632 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011633 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011634 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11635 scopes allowed are:
11636 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11637 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11638 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11639 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11640 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011641 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011642
11643and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011644 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011645 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011646 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11647 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11648 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11649 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11650 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11651 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11652 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011653 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011654
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011655base64
11656 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11657 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11658 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11659
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011660bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011661 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011662 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11663 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11664 presence of a flag).
11665
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011666bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11667 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11668 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11669 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11670
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011671cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011672 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11673 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011674
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011675crc32([<avalanche>])
11676 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11677 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11678 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11679 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11680 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11681 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11682 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11683 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11684 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11685 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11686 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11687
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011688da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011689 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11690 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11691 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11692 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011693 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011694 configuration language.
11695
11696 Example:
11697 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011698 bind *:8881
11699 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011700 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011701
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011702debug
11703 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11704 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11705 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11706
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011707div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011708 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11709 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011710 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011711 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11712 scope. The scopes allowed are:
11713 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11714 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11715 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11716 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11717 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011718 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011719
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011720djb2([<avalanche>])
11721 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11722 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11723 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11724 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11725 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11726 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11727 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011728 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11729 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011730
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011731even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011732 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011733 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11734
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011735field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11736 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11737 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11738 list of chars.
11739
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011740hex
11741 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11742 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11743 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11744 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011745
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011746http_date([<offset>])
11747 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11748 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11749 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11750 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11751 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11752 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011753
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011754in_table(<table>)
11755 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11756 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11757 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11758 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11759 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11760
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011761ipmask(<mask>)
11762 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11763 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11764 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11765 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11766
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011767json([<input-code>])
11768 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11769 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11770 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11771 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11772 of errors:
11773 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11774 bytes, ...)
11775 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11776 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11777
11778 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11779 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11780 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11781 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11782 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11783 are :
11784 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11785 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11786 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11787 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11788 error ;
11789 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11790 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11791
11792 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11793 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11794
11795 Example:
11796 capture request header user-agent len 150
11797 capture request header Host len 15
Mac Browninge83345d2016-03-14 14:46:01 -040011798 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json("utf8s")]"}
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011799
11800 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11801 GET / HTTP/1.0
11802 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11803
11804 Output log:
11805 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11806
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011807language(<value>[,<default>])
11808 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11809 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11810 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11811 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11812 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11813 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11814 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11815 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11816 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11817 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11818 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11819 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011820
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011821 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011822
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011823 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11824 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011825
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011826 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11827 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11828 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11829 use_backend spanish if es
11830 use_backend french if fr
11831 use_backend english if en
11832 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011833
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011834lower
11835 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11836 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11837 type. The result is of type string.
11838
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011839ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11840 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11841 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11842 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11843 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11844 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11845 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11846
11847 Example :
11848
11849 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11850 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11851 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011853map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11854map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11855map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11856 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11857 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11858 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11859 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11860 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11861 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11862 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11863 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011864
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011865 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11866 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11867 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011868
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011869 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11870 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011871
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011872 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11873 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11874 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11875 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011876 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11877 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011878 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11879 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11880 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11881 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11882 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11883 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11884 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11885 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010011886 | | map_reg | |
11887 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11888 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011889 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11890 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11891 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11892 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11893 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011894
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010011895 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
11896 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
11897 the corresponding match text.
11898
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011899 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11900 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11901 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11902 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11903 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011904
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011905 Example :
11906
11907 # this is a comment and is ignored
11908 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11909 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11910 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11911 | | | `---------- value
11912 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11913 | `---------------------------- key
11914 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11915
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011916mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011917 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11918 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011919 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011920 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11921 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11922 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11923 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11924 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11925 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011926 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011927
11928mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011929 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011930 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11931 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011932 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011933 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11934 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11935 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11936 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11937 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11938 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011939 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011940
11941neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011942 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11943 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11944 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11945 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011946
11947not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011948 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011949 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11950 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11951 absence of a flag).
11952
11953odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011954 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011955 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11956
11957or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011958 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011959 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011960 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11961 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11962 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11963 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11964 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11965 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011967 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011968
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011969regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011970 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11971 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11972 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11973 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11974 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11975 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11976 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11977 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11978 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11979 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010011980 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
11981 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
11982 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
11983 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011984
11985 Example :
11986
11987 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11988 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11989 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11990 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11991
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011992capture-req(<id>)
11993 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11994 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11995
11996 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020011997 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
11998 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011999
12000capture-res(<id>)
12001 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12002 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12003
12004 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012005 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12006 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012007
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012008sdbm([<avalanche>])
12009 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12010 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12011 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12012 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12013 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12014 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12015 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012016 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12017 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012018
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012019set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012020 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12021 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12022 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12023 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12024 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012025 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012026 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12027 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012028 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12029 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12030
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012031sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012032 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12033 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012034 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012035 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12036 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12037 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12038 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012039 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012040 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12041 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012042 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12043 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012044
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012045table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12048 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12049 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12050 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12051 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12052
12053
12054table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12058 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12059 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12060 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12061
12062table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12063 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12064 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12065 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12066 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12067 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12068
12069table_conn_cur(<table>)
12070 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12071 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12072 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12073 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12074 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12075
12076table_conn_rate(<table>)
12077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12080 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12081 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12082
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012083table_gpt0(<table>)
12084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12086 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12087 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12088 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12089
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012090table_gpc0(<table>)
12091 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12092 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12093 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12094 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12095 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12096
12097table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12098 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12099 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12100 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12101 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12102 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12103 sample fetch keyword.
12104
12105table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12106 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12107 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12108 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12109 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12110 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12111
12112table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12113 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12114 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12115 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12116 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12117 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12118 keyword.
12119
12120table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12121 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12122 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12123 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12124 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12125 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12126
12127table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12128 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12129 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12130 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12131 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12132 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12133 keyword.
12134
12135table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12136 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12137 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12138 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12139 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12140 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12141 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12142 keyword.
12143
12144table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12145 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12146 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12147 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12148 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12149 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12150 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12151 keyword.
12152
12153table_server_id(<table>)
12154 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12155 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12156 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12157 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12158 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12159 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12160
12161table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12162 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12163 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12164 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12165 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12166 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12167 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12168 keyword.
12169
12170table_sess_rate(<table>)
12171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12174 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12175 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12176 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12177 keyword.
12178
12179table_trackers(<table>)
12180 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12181 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12182 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12183 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12184 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12185 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12186 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12187 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12188 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12189 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12190
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012191upper
12192 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12193 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12194 type. The result is of type string.
12195
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012196url_dec
12197 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12198 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12199
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012200utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12201 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12202 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12203 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12204 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12205 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12206 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12207
12208 Example :
12209
12210 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12211 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12212 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12213
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012214word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12215 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12216 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12217
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012218wt6([<avalanche>])
12219 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12220 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12221 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12222 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12223 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12224 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12225 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012226 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12227 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012228
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012229xor(<value>)
12230 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012231 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012232 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012233 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12234 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12235 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012236 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012237 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12238 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012239 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12240 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012241
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012242
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200122437.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012244--------------------------------------------
12245
12246A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12247not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12248"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12249The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12250
12251always_false : boolean
12252 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12253 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12254
12255always_true : boolean
12256 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12257 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12258
12259avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012260 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012261 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12262 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12263 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12264 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12265 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12266 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12267 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12268 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12269 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12270 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12271 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12272 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12273 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012275be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012276 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12277 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12278 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12279 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12280 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012282be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12283 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12284 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12285 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12286 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12287 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12288 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012289
12290 Example :
12291 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12292 backend dynamic
12293 mode http
12294 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12295 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012296
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012297bin(<hexa>) : bin
12298 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12299 of the string.
12300
12301bool(<bool>) : bool
12302 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12303 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012305connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12306 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012307 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012308 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12309 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012310
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012311 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012312 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012313 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12314
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012315 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12316 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012317
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012318 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012319 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012320 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012321 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12322 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012323 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012324 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012325
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012326 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12327 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012328 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012329 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012330
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012331date([<offset>]) : integer
12332 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12333 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12334 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12335 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012336 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12337
12338 Example :
12339
12340 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12341 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012342
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012343env(<name>) : string
12344 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12345 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12346 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12347 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12348 certain way.
12349
12350 Examples :
12351 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12352 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12353
12354 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12355 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012357fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12358 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012359 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12360 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012361 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12362 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12363 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12364 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12365 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012367fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12369 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12370 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12371 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12372 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12373 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12374 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12375 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012376
12377 Example :
12378 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12379 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12380 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12381 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12382 frontend mail
12383 bind :25
12384 mode tcp
12385 maxconn 100
12386 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12387 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12388 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12389 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012390
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012391int(<integer>) : signed integer
12392 Returns a signed integer.
12393
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012394ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12395 Returns an ipv4.
12396
12397ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12398 Returns an ipv6.
12399
12400meth(<method>) : method
12401 Returns a method.
12402
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012403nbproc : integer
12404 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12405 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12406 and debugging purposes.
12407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012408nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12409 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12410 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12411 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012412 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12413 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12414 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012415
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012416proc : integer
12417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12418 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12419 debugging purposes.
12420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012421queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012422 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12423 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12424 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12426 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12427 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12428 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12429 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12430
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012431rand([<range>]) : integer
12432 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12433 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12434 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12435 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12436 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012438srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12439 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12440 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12441 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12442 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12443 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12444 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12445 methods.
12446
12447srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12448 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12449 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12450 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12451 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12452 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12453 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12454 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12455
12456srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12457 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12458 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012459 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012460 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12461 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12462 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12463 overloading servers).
12464
12465 Example :
12466 # Redirect to a separate back
12467 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12468 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12469 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12470
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012471stopping : boolean
12472 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12473 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12474 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12475
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012476str(<string>) : string
12477 Returns a string.
12478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012479table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12480 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12481 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12482
12483table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12484 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12485 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12486 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12487
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012488var(<var-name>) : undefined
12489 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012490 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12491 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12492 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12493 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012494 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012495 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12496 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012497 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12498 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12499
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200125007.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501----------------------------------
12502
12503The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12504closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12505methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12506sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12507TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012508the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12509counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12510"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012511argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12512the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12513this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012514
12515be_id : integer
12516 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12517 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12518
12519dst : ip
12520 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12521 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12522 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12523 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12524 RFC 4291.
12525
12526dst_conn : integer
12527 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12528 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12529 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12530 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12531 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12532 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12533 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12534 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012536dst_port : integer
12537 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12538 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12539 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12540 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12541 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12542 an HTTP header.
12543
12544fe_id : integer
12545 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12546 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12547 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12548
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012549sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012550sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12551sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12552sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012553 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12554 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12555 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012557sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012558sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12559sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12560sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012561 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12562 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12563 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12564
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012565sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012566sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12567sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12568sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012569 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12570 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012571 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12572 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12573 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012574
12575 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12576 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012577 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12578 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12579 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012580 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12581 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12582
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012583sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012584sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12585sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12586sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012587 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12588 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12589
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012590sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012591sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12592sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12593sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012594 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12595 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12596 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12597
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012598sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012599sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12600sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12601sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012602 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12603 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12604 See also src_conn_rate.
12605
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012606sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012607sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12608sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12609sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012610 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012611 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012612
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012613sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12614sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12615sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12616sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12617 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12618 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12619
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012620sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012621sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12622sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12623sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012624 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12625 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12626 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012627 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12628 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12629 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012631sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012632sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12633sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12634sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012635 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12636 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12637 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12638
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012639sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012640sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12641sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12642sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012643 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12644 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12645 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12646 src_http_err_rate.
12647
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012648sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012649sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12650sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12651sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012652 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12653 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12654 src_http_req_cnt.
12655
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012656sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012657sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12658sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12659sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012660 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12661 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12662 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12663 src_http_req_rate.
12664
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012665sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012666sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12667sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12668sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012669 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012670 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12671 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12672 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12673 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012674
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012675 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12676 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012677 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12678
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012679sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012680sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12681sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12682sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012683 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12684 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12685 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012686
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012687sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012688sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12689sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12690sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012691 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12692 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12693 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012694
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012695sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012696sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12697sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12698sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012699 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12700 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12701 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12702 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012703 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012704 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12705
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012706sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012707sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12708sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12709sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012710 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12711 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12712 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12713 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12714 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012715 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012716
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012717sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012718sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12719sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12720sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012721 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12722 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12723 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12724
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012725sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012726sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12727sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12728sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012729 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12730 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012731 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012732 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12733 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012734 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12735 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12736 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012738so_id : integer
12739 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12740 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12741 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012743src : ip
12744 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12745 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12746 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12747 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12748 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12749 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12750 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012751
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012752 Example:
12753 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12754 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012756src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12757 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12758 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12759 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012760 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012762src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12763 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12764 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012765 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012766 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12769 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12770 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12771 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12772 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12773 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12774 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012775
12776 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12777 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12778 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12779 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012780 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012781 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12782 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012784src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012785 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012787 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012788 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012790src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012791 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012792 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12793 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012794 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012796src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12797 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12798 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12799 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012800 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012802src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012803 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012804 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012805 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012806 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012807
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012808src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12809 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12810 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12811 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12812 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012815 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012816 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012817 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12818 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012819 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12820 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12821 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012823src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12824 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12825 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012826 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012827 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012828 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12831 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12832 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12833 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12834 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012835 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12838 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12839 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12840 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012841 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012843src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12844 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12845 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12846 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012847 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012848 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012850src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12851 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12852 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12853 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012854 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012855 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12856 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012857
12858 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012859 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012860 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012863 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12864 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12865 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12866 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12867 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012869src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012870 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12871 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12872 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12873 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12874 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012876src_port : integer
12877 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12878 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12879 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12880 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012882src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12883 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012884 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12885 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12886 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012887 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012889src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12890 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12891 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12892 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12893 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012894 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12897 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12898 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12899 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12900 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12901 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12902 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12903 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12904 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012905
12906 Example :
12907 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12908 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12909 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12910 listen ssh
12911 bind :22
12912 mode tcp
12913 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012914 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012916 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918srv_id : integer
12919 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12920 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12921 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012922
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012923
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129247.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012927The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12928closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12929when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12930usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012931future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012932
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012933ssl_bc : boolean
12934 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12935 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12936 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12937
12938ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12939 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12940 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12941
12942ssl_bc_cipher : string
12943 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12944 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12945
12946ssl_bc_protocol : string
12947 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12948 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12949
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012950ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012951 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012952 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12953 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012954
12955ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12956 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12957 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12958 if session was reused or not.
12959
12960ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12961 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12962 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012964ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12965 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12966 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12967 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12968 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12969 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012971ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12972 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12973 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12974 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12975 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012976
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012977ssl_c_der : binary
12978 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12979 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12980 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012982ssl_c_err : integer
12983 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12984 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12985 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12986 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12987 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12990 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12991 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12992 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12993 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12994 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12995 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12996 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12997 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999ssl_c_key_alg : string
13000 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13001 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13002 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004ssl_c_notafter : string
13005 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13006 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13007 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013009ssl_c_notbefore : string
13010 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13011 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13012 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013014ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13015 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13016 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13017 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13018 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13019 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13020 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13021 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13022 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024ssl_c_serial : binary
13025 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13026 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13027 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013029ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13030 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13031 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13032 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013033 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13034 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13035
13036 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13039 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13040 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13041 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013043ssl_c_used : boolean
13044 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13045 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047ssl_c_verify : integer
13048 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13049 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13050 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13051 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053ssl_c_version : integer
13054 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13055 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013056
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013057ssl_f_der : binary
13058 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13059 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13060 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13063 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13064 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13065 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13066 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013067 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13069 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13070 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013072ssl_f_key_alg : string
13073 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13074 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13075 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077ssl_f_notafter : string
13078 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13079 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13080 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013082ssl_f_notbefore : string
13083 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13084 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13085 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13088 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13089 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13090 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13091 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13092 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13093 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13094 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13095 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013097ssl_f_serial : binary
13098 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13099 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13100 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013101
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013102ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13103 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13104 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13105 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013107ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13108 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13109 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13110 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112ssl_f_version : integer
13113 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13114 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13115
13116ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013117 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13118 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13119 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013121 Example :
13122 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13123 listen http-https
13124 bind :80
13125 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13126 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13127
13128ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13129 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13130 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13131
13132ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013133 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013134 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13135 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13136 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13137 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13138 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13139 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13140 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13141 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013143ssl_fc_cipher : string
13144 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13145 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013147ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013148 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13149 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013150 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13151 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13152 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13153 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13156 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013157 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13158 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13159 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13160 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013161
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013162ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
13163 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13164 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013166ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013167 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13169 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13170 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13171 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13172 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13173 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13174 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013176ssl_fc_protocol : string
13177 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13178 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013179
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013180ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013181 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013182 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13183 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13186 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13187 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13188 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13189 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013191ssl_fc_sni : string
13192 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13193 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13194 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13195 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13196 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13197
13198 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13199 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13200 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013201 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13202 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013204 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013205 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13206 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13209 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13210 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013211
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013212
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132137.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013214------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013216Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13217sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13218only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13219For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13220be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13221can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13222sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13223for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13224content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013226payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13227 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13228 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13229 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13232 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13233 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13234 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013236req.len : integer
13237req_len : integer (deprecated)
13238 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13239 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13240 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13241 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13242 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13243 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13244 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13245 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013247req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13248 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013249 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13250 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13251 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13252 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013254 ACL alternatives :
13255 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13258 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13259 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13260 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13261 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013263 ACL alternatives :
13264 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013266 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013268req.proto_http : boolean
13269req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13270 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13271 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13272 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13273 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13274 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13275 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13276 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013278 Example:
13279 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13280 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13281 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013282 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13285rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13286 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13287 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13288 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13289 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13290 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13291 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13292 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013294 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13295 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13296 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13297 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13298 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13299 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013301 ACL derivatives :
13302 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304 Example :
13305 listen tse-farm
13306 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13307 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13308 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13309 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13310 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13311 persist rdp-cookie
13312 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13313 # This is only useful makes sense if
13314 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13315 stick-table type string size 204800
13316 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13317 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13318 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013320 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13321 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013323req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13324rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13325 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13326 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13327 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13328 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013330 ACL derivatives :
13331 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013332
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013333req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13334 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13335 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013336 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13337 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13338 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13339 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13340 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013342req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13343req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13344 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13345 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13346 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13347 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13348 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13349 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13350 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013352req.ssl_sni : string
13353req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13354 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13355 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13356 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13357 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13358 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13359 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13360 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13361 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13362 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13363 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13364 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13365 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013367 ACL derivatives :
13368 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370 Examples :
13371 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13372 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13373 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13374 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13375 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013376
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013377req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13378 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13379 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13380 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13381 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13382 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13383 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13384 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13385 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13386 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013388req.ssl_ver : integer
13389req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13390 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13391 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13392 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13393 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13394 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13395 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13396 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13397 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13398 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013400 ACL derivatives :
13401 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013402
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013403res.len : integer
13404 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13405 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13406 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13407 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13408 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13409 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13410 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13411 content inspection.
13412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013413res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13414 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013415 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13416 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13417 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13418 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13421 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13422 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13423 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13424 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013427
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013428res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13429rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13430 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13431 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13432 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13433 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13434 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13435 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13436 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013438wait_end : boolean
13439 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13440 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13441 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13442 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13443 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13444 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13445 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13446 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013448 Examples :
13449 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13450 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13451 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013453 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13454 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13455 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13456 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13457 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13458 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13459 tcp-request content reject
13460
13461
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134627.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463--------------------------------------
13464
13465It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13466This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13467data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13468its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13469HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13470content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13471to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13472more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13473response are indexed.
13474
13475base : string
13476 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13477 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13478 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13479 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13480 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13481 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13482 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13483 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13484
13485 ACL derivatives :
13486 base : exact string match
13487 base_beg : prefix match
13488 base_dir : subdir match
13489 base_dom : domain match
13490 base_end : suffix match
13491 base_len : length match
13492 base_reg : regex match
13493 base_sub : substring match
13494
13495base32 : integer
13496 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13497 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13498 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013499 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13500 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13501 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013502
13503base32+src : binary
13504 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13505 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13506 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13507 per-URL counters.
13508
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013509capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13510 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13511 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13512 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13513
13514capture.req.method : string
13515 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13516 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13517 because it's allocated.
13518
13519capture.req.uri : string
13520 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13521 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13522 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13523 allocated.
13524
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013525capture.req.ver : string
13526 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13527 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13528 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13529
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013530capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13531 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13532 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13533 The first entry is an index of 0.
13534 See also: "capture response header"
13535
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013536capture.res.ver : string
13537 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13538 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13539 persistent flag.
13540
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013541req.body : binary
13542 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13543 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13544 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13545 the first chunk is analyzed.
13546
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013547req.body_param([<name>) : string
13548 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13549 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13550 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13551 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13552 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13553 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13554 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13555 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13556 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13557 given.
13558
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013559req.body_len : integer
13560 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13561 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13562 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13563 "option http-buffer-request".
13564
13565req.body_size : integer
13566 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13567 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13568 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13569 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13570 "option http-buffer-request".
13571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013572req.cook([<name>]) : string
13573cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13574 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13575 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13576 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13577 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13578 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13579 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13580 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13581 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13582
13583 ACL derivatives :
13584 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13585 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13586 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13587 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13588 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13589 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13590 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13591 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013593req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13594cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13595 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13596 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013598req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13599cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13600 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13601 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13602 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13603 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013605cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13606 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13607 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13608 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13609 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013610 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013611 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13612 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13613 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13614 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13617 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13618 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13619 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13620 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013621 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13624 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13625 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13626 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13627 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13628 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13629 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13630 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13631 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013633req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13634 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13635 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13636 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13637 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013639req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13640 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13641 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13642 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13643 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13644 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13645 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13646 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13647 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13648 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13649 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13650 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013652 ACL derivatives :
13653 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13654 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13655 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13656 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13657 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13658 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13659 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13660 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13661
13662req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13663hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13664 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13665 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13666 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13667 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13668 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13669 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13670 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13671 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13672 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13673
13674req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13675hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13676 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13677 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13678 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13679 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13680 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13681 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13682 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13683 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13684
13685req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13686hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13687 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13688 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13689 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13690 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13691 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13692 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13693 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13694
13695http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13696 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13697 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13698 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13699 basic auth is supported.
13700
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013701http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13702 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13703 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13704 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13705 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013706 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13707 basic auth is supported.
13708
13709 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013710 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13711 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13712 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13713 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714
13715http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013716 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13717 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013718 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13719 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721method : integer + string
13722 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13723 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13724 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13725 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13726 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13727 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13728 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013730 ACL derivatives :
13731 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013733 Example :
13734 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13735 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13736 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013738path : string
13739 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13740 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13741 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13742 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13743 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13744 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13745 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747 ACL derivatives :
13748 path : exact string match
13749 path_beg : prefix match
13750 path_dir : subdir match
13751 path_dom : domain match
13752 path_end : suffix match
13753 path_len : length match
13754 path_reg : regex match
13755 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013756
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013757query : string
13758 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13759 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13760 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13761 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13762 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13763 which stops before the question mark.
13764
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013765req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13766 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13767 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13768 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13769 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013771req.ver : string
13772req_ver : string (deprecated)
13773 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13774 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13775 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013777 ACL derivatives :
13778 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013780res.comp : boolean
13781 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13782 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13783 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013785res.comp_algo : string
13786 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13787 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13788 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790res.cook([<name>]) : string
13791scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13792 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13793 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13794 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013796 ACL derivatives :
13797 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013799res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13800scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13801 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13802 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13803 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013805res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13806scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13807 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13808 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13809 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13812 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13813 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13814 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13815 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13816 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13817 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13818 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13819 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13820 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013822res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13823 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13824 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13825 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13826 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13827 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013829res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13830shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13831 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13832 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13833 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13834 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13835 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13836 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13837 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13838 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013840 ACL derivatives :
13841 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13842 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13843 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13844 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13845 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13846 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13847 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13848 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13849
13850res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13851shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13852 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13853 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13854 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13855 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13856 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013858res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13859shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13860 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13861 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13862 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13863 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13864 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13865 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013866
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013867res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13868 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13869 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13870 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13871 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013873res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13874shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13875 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13876 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13877 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13878 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13879 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13880 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013882res.ver : string
13883resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13884 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13885 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013887 ACL derivatives :
13888 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13891 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13892 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013893 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013894 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013896 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13897 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013899status : integer
13900 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13901 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13902 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013903
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020013904unique-id : string
13905 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
13906 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
13907 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
13908 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
13909 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
13910 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
13911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013912url : string
13913 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13914 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13915 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13916 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13917 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13918 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13919 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013921 ACL derivatives :
13922 url : exact string match
13923 url_beg : prefix match
13924 url_dir : subdir match
13925 url_dom : domain match
13926 url_end : suffix match
13927 url_len : length match
13928 url_reg : regex match
13929 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013931url_ip : ip
13932 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13933 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13934 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13935 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13936 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13937 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13938 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013940url_port : integer
13941 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13942 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13943 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13944 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013945
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013946urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13947url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013948 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13949 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013950 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13951 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13952 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13953 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13955 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013956 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13957 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013959 ACL derivatives :
13960 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13961 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13962 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13963 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13964 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13965 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13966 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13967 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013968
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970 Example :
13971 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13972 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13973 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13974 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013975
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013976urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013977 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13978 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13979 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013980
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139827.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013983---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013985Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13986every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013987order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013989ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13990---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013991FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013992HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013993HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13994HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013995HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13996HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13997HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13998HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13999LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014000METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
14001METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14002METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14003METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14004METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
14005METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014006RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014007REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014008TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014009WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14010---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014011
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140138. Logging
14014----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014015
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014016One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14017provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14018very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14019provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14020state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014021to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014022headers.
14023
14024In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14025about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14026send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14027
14028 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14029 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14030 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14031 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14032 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014033 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14034 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014035
14036The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14037allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14038as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14039while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14040real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14041delay.
14042
14043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140448.1. Log levels
14045---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014046
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014047TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014048source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014049HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14050in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14051track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14052syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14053about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014054
14055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140568.2. Log formats
14057----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014058
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014059HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014060and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14061slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14062options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014063
14064 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14065 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14066 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14067 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14068 extents.
14069
14070 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14071 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14072 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14073 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14074 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14075
14076 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14077 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14078 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14079 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14080 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14081
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014082 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14083 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14084 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14085 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14086
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014087 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14088
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014089Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14090specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14091field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14092servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14093always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14094identifier.
14095
14096Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14097 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14098 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14099 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14100 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14101
14102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141038.2.1. Default log format
14104-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014105
14106This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14107as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14108format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14109
14110 Example :
14111 listen www
14112 mode http
14113 log global
14114 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14115
14116 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14117 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14118 (www/HTTP)
14119
14120 Field Format Extract from the example above
14121 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14122 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14123 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14124 4 'to' to
14125 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14126 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14127
14128Detailed fields description :
14129 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14130 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14131 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14132 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14133 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14134 and processed the connection.
14135 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14136
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014137In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14138"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14139connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14140
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014141It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14142will eventually disappear.
14143
14144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141458.2.2. TCP log format
14146---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014147
14148The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14149is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14150information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14151counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14152emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14153environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14154the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14155sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014156specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14157not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14158fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14159marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014160
14161 Example :
14162 frontend fnt
14163 mode tcp
14164 option tcplog
14165 log global
14166 default_backend bck
14167
14168 backend bck
14169 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14170
14171 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14172 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14173 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14174
14175 Field Format Extract from the example above
14176 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14177 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14178 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14179 4 frontend_name fnt
14180 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14181 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14182 7 bytes_read* 212
14183 8 termination_state --
14184 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14185 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14186
14187Detailed fields description :
14188 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014189 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14190 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14191 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14192 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14193 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014194
14195 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014196 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14197 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14198 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014199
14200 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14201 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14202 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14203 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14204
14205 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14206 and processed the connection.
14207
14208 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14209 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14210 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14211 applications.
14212
14213 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14214 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14215 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14216 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14217 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14218
14219 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14220 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14221 See "Timers" below for more details.
14222
14223 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14224 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14225 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14226 "Timers" below for more details.
14227
14228 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014229 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014230 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14231 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14232 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14233 details.
14234
14235 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14236 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14237 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14238 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14239 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14240
14241 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14242 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14243 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14244 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14245 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14246 for more details.
14247
14248 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014249 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014250 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14251 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14252 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014253 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014254
14255 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14256 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14257 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14258 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14259 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14260 caused by a denial of service attack.
14261
14262 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14263 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14264 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14265 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14266 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14267 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14268 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14269 denial of service attack.
14270
14271 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14272 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14273 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14274 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14275 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14276 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14277 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14278 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14279 be processed than on other servers.
14280
14281 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14282 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14283 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14284 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14285 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14286 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14287 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14288 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14289 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14290 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14291 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14292 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14293 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14294
14295 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14296 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14297 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14298 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14299 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14300 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14301 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14302 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14303
14304 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14305 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14306 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14307 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14308 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14309 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14310 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14311 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14312 occurs.
14313
14314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143158.2.3. HTTP log format
14316----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014317
14318The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14319is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14320the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14321are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14322emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14323generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14324"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14325which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014326frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14327is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014328
14329Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14330slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14331with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14332
14333 Example :
14334 frontend http-in
14335 mode http
14336 option httplog
14337 log global
14338 default_backend bck
14339
14340 backend static
14341 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14342
14343 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14344 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14345 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014346 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014347
14348 Field Format Extract from the example above
14349 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14350 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14351 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14352 4 frontend_name http-in
14353 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14354 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14355 7 status_code 200
14356 8 bytes_read* 2750
14357 9 captured_request_cookie -
14358 10 captured_response_cookie -
14359 11 termination_state ----
14360 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14361 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14362 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14363 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14364 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014365
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014366
14367Detailed fields description :
14368 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014369 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14370 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14371 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14372 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14373 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014374
14375 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014376 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14377 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14378 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014379
14380 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14381 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14382 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14383 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14384 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14385
14386 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14387 and processed the connection.
14388
14389 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14390 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14391 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14392
14393 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14394 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14395 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14396 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14397 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14398 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14399
14400 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14401 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14402 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14403 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14404 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14405 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14406
14407 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14408 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14409 See "Timers" below for more details.
14410
14411 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14412 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14413 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14414 below for more details.
14415
14416 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14417 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14418 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14419 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14420 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14421 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14422 for more details.
14423
14424 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014425 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014426 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14427 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14428 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14429 details.
14430
14431 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14432 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14433 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14434
14435 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14436 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14437 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14438 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14439 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14440 overflowing.
14441
14442 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14443 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14444 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14445 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14446 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14447 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14448 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14449 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14450
14451 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14452 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14453 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14454 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14455 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14456 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14457 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14458 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14459
14460 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14461 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14462 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14463 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14464 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14465 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14466 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14467
14468 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014469 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014470 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14471 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14472 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014473 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014474 system.
14475
14476 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14477 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14478 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14479 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14480 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14481 caused by a denial of service attack.
14482
14483 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14484 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14485 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14486 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14487 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14488 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14489 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14490 denial of service attack.
14491
14492 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14493 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14494 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14495 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14496 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14497 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14498 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14499 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14500 processed than on other servers.
14501
14502 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14503 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14504 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14505 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14506 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14507 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14508 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14509 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14510 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14511 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14512 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14513 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14514 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14515
14516 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14517 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14518 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14519 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14520 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14521 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14522 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14523 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14524
14525 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14526 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14527 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14528 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14529 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14530 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14531 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14532 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14533 occurs.
14534
14535 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14536 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14537 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14538 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14539 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14540 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14541 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14542 cookies" below for more details.
14543
14544 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14545 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14546 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14547 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14548 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14549 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14550 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14551 and cookies" below for more details.
14552
14553 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14554 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14555 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14556 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14557 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14558 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14559 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14560 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14561
14562
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200145638.2.4. Custom log format
14564------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014565
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014566The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014567mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014568
14569HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14570Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14571separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14572prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14573
14574Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14575variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014576("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014577
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014578If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014579as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014580less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14581the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14582
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014583Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014584In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014585in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014586
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014587Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14588'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14589https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14590such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14591
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014592Flags are :
14593 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014594 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014595 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14596 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014597
14598 Example:
14599
14600 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14601 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14602
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014603 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14604
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014605At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14606
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014607 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14608 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014609
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014610the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014611
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014612 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014613 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014614 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014615
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014616and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14617
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014618 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014619 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14620
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014621Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14622
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014623 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014624 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014625 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14626 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14627 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014628 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14629 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14630 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014631 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014632 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14633 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014634 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014635 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14636 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014637 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014638 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014639 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014640 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014641 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014642 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14643 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014644 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014645 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14646 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014647 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014648 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14649 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014650 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14651 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14652 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014653 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014654 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14655 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014656 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014657 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14658 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14659 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014660 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014661 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014662 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14663 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14664 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14665 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014666 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014667 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014668 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014669 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014670 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014671 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014672 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14673 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14674 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014675 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014676 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14677 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014678 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014679 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014680 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014681 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014682
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014683 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014684
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014685
146868.2.5. Error log format
14687-----------------------
14688
14689When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14690protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14691By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14692"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14693will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14694logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14695
14696The format looks like this :
14697
14698 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14699 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14700 Connection error during SSL handshake
14701
14702 Field Format Extract from the example above
14703 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14704 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14705 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14706 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14707 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14708
14709These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14710failures.
14711
14712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147138.3. Advanced logging options
14714-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014715
14716Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14717just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14718options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14719for more information about their usage.
14720
14721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147228.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14723------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014724
14725It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14726haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14727commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14728monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14729ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14730
14731 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14732 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14733 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14734 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14735
14736 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14737 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14738 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014739 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014740 such as other load-balancers.
14741
14742 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14743 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14744 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14745
14746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147478.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14748----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014749
14750The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14751what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14752or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14753"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14754just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14755log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14756after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14757is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14758with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14759with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14760
14761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147628.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14763------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014764
14765Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14766for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14767"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14768retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14769raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14770a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14771file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14772you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14773"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14774
14775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147768.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14777--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014778
14779Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14780multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14781them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14782"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14783logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14784error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14785and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14786too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14787useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14788alternative.
14789
14790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147918.4. Timing events
14792------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014793
14794Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14795reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14796the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14797frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14798mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14799
14800 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14801 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14802 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14803 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14804 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14805
14806 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14807 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14808 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14809 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14810 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14811
14812 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14813 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14814 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14815 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14816 connection never established.
14817
14818 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14819 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14820 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14821 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14822 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14823 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14824 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14825 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14826 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14827 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14828 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14829
14830 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14831 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14832 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14833 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014834 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014835
14836 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14837
14838 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14839 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14840 negative.
14841
14842These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14843protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14844that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014845due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014846close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14847session has been aborted on timeout.
14848
14849Most common cases :
14850
14851 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14852 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14853 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14854 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14855 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14856 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14857 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14858 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14859 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010014860 connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive modes
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014861 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14862 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014863
14864 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14865 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14866 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14867 of ms on remote networks.
14868
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014869 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14870 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14871 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014872
14873 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14874 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14875 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14876 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14877 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14878 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14879 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14880 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14881 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14882 to the server until another one is released.
14883
14884Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14885
14886 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14887 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14888 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14889
14890 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14891 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14892 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14893
14894 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14895 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14896 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14897 flags.
14898
14899 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14900 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14901 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14902 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14903 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14904 the client connection was maintained open.
14905
14906 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014907 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014908 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14909 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14910
14911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149128.5. Session state at disconnection
14913-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014914
14915TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14916"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
149172-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14918each of which has a special meaning :
14919
14920 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14921 session to terminate :
14922
14923 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14924
14925 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14926 server explicitly refused it.
14927
14928 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14929 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14930 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14931 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014932 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14933
14934 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14935 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014936
14937 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14938 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14939 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14940 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14941 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14942
14943 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14944 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14945 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14946 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14947 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14948
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014949 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14950 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14951
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014952 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14953 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14954 backup connections when going up.
14955
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014956 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14957
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014958 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14959 send or receive data.
14960
14961 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14962 send or receive data.
14963
14964 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14965 with nothing left in the buffers.
14966
14967 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14968
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014969 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014970 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14971
14972 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14973 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14974 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14975 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14976 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14977
14978 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14979 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14980
14981 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14982 server (HTTP only).
14983
14984 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14985
14986 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14987 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14988 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14989
14990 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14991 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14992 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14993
14994 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14995
14996 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14997 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14998
14999 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15000 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15001 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15002
15003 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15004 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015005 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15006 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015007
15008 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15009 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15010 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15011 another server.
15012
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015013 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015014 server.
15015
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015016 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15017 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15018 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15019 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15020
15021 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15022 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15023 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15024 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15025
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015026 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15027 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15028 "use-server" rule).
15029
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015030 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15031
15032 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15033 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15034
15035 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15036
15037 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15038 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15039 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15040
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015041 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15042 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015043 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015044 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15045 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15046
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015047 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15048
15049 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15050 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15051
15052 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15053
15054 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15055
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015056The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15057was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015058helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15059starvation, attacks, etc...
15060
15061The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15062alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15063easier finding and understanding.
15064
15065 Flags Reason
15066
15067 -- Normal termination.
15068
15069 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15070 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15071 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15072 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15073
15074 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15075 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15076 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15077 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15078 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15079 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015080
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015081 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15082 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015083 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015084
15085 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15086 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15087 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15088
15089 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15090 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15091 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15092 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15093 the server takes too long to respond.
15094
15095 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15096 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15097 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15098 long a time to respond.
15099
15100 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15101 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15102 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15103 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015104 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15105 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015106
15107 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15108 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15109 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15110 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15111 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015112 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015113 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15114 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15115 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15116 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15117 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15118 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15119 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15120 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15121 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15122 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15123 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15124 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015125
15126 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15127 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015128 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15129 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15130 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15131 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015132
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015133 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15134 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015136 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015137 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15138 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15139 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15140 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15141 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15142
15143 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15144 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15145 503 or 504 here.
15146
15147 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15148 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15149 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15150 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15151 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15152
15153 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15154 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015155 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015156 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15157 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15158
15159 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15160 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15161 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15162 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15163 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15164 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15165 between haproxy and the server.
15166
15167 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15168 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15169 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15170 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15171 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15172 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15173 solution is to fix the application.
15174
15175 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15176 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15177 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15178 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15179 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15180 external attacks.
15181
15182 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15183 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015184 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015185 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15186 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15187
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015188 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15189 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15190 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015191 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15192 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015193
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015194 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15195 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15196 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15197 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015198 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15199 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15200 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15201 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15202 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015203
15204 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15205 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15206 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15207 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15208
15209 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15210 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15211 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15212 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15213
15214 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15215 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15216 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15217 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15218
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015219The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15220persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15221important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15222re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15223
15224 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15225
15226 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15227 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15228 set on a GET request.
15229
15230 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15231 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015232 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015233 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15234
15235 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15236 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15237 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15238
15239 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15240 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15241 already got a cookie.
15242
15243 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15244 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15245 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15246 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15247 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15248
15249 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15250 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15251 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15252
15253 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15254 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15255 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15256
15257 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15258 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15259
15260 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15261 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15262 then advertised in the response.
15263
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152658.6. Non-printable characters
15266-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015267
15268In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15269consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15270converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15271prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15272being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15273escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15274is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15275'}' when logging headers.
15276
15277Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15278issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15279containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15280
15281Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15282the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15283performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15284
15285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15287---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015288
15289Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15290achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015291section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015292cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15293the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15294the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015295locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015296not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15297user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15298a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15299wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15300
15301 Examples :
15302 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15303 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15304
15305 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15306 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15307
15308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153098.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15310---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015311
15312Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15313proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15314the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15315server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15316
15317Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15318response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015319section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015320
15321It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015322time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15323appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015324are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15325and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15326follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15327request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15328in the logs.
15329
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015330As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15331frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15332an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015334 Example :
15335 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15336 listen proxy-out
15337 mode http
15338 option httplog
15339 option logasap
15340 log global
15341 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15342
15343 # log the name of the virtual server
15344 capture request header Host len 20
15345
15346 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15347 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15348
15349 # log the beginning of the referrer
15350 capture request header Referer len 20
15351
15352 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15353 capture response header Server len 20
15354
15355 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15356 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15357
15358 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15359 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15360
15361 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15362 capture response header Via len 20
15363
15364 # log the URL location during a redirection
15365 capture response header Location len 20
15366
15367 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15368 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15369 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15370 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15371 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15372
15373 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15374 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15375 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15376 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015377 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015378
15379 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15380 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15381 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15382 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15383 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015384 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015385
15386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153878.9. Examples of logs
15388---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015389
15390These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15391them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15392reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15393
15394 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15395 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15396 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15397
15398 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15399 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15400
15401 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15402 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15403 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15404
15405 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15406 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15407
15408 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15409 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15410 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15411
15412 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015413 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015414 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15415 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15416
15417 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15418 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15419 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15420
15421 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15422 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015423 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015424 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15425 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15426 to return the 502 and not the server.
15427
15428 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015429 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015430
15431 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15432 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15433 Nothing was sent to any server.
15434
15435 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15436 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15437
15438 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15439 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15440 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15441 send a 408 return code to the client.
15442
15443 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15444 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15445
15446 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15447 5 seconds ("c----").
15448
15449 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15450 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015451 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015452
15453 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015454 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015455 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15456 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15457 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15458 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15459 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015460
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015462/*
15463 * Local variables:
15464 * fill-column: 79
15465 * End:
15466 */